[go: up one dir, main page]

WO2008050101A2 - Benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds useful in the treatment of a disease mediated through glk - Google Patents

Benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds useful in the treatment of a disease mediated through glk Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2008050101A2
WO2008050101A2 PCT/GB2007/004018 GB2007004018W WO2008050101A2 WO 2008050101 A2 WO2008050101 A2 WO 2008050101A2 GB 2007004018 W GB2007004018 W GB 2007004018W WO 2008050101 A2 WO2008050101 A2 WO 2008050101A2
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
alkyl
oxy
methyl
ring
oxo
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Ceased
Application number
PCT/GB2007/004018
Other languages
French (fr)
Other versions
WO2008050101A3 (en
Inventor
Leonie Campbell
Kurt Gordon Pike
Abid Suleman
Michael James Waring
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
AstraZeneca UK Ltd
AstraZeneca AB
Original Assignee
AstraZeneca UK Ltd
AstraZeneca AB
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Priority to MX2009004362A priority Critical patent/MX2009004362A/en
Priority to AU2007310608A priority patent/AU2007310608A1/en
Priority to BRPI0718504-9A priority patent/BRPI0718504A2/en
Priority to EP07824267A priority patent/EP2086964A2/en
Priority to JP2009533935A priority patent/JP2010507640A/en
Priority to CA002667435A priority patent/CA2667435A1/en
Application filed by AstraZeneca UK Ltd, AstraZeneca AB filed Critical AstraZeneca UK Ltd
Publication of WO2008050101A2 publication Critical patent/WO2008050101A2/en
Publication of WO2008050101A3 publication Critical patent/WO2008050101A3/en
Priority to IL198142A priority patent/IL198142A0/en
Priority to NO20091599A priority patent/NO20091599L/en
Anticipated expiration legal-status Critical
Ceased legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D401/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom
    • C07D401/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing three or more hetero rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/41Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with two or more ring hetero atoms, at least one of which being nitrogen, e.g. tetrazole
    • A61K31/4151,2-Diazoles
    • A61K31/41551,2-Diazoles non condensed and containing further heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • A61P3/04Anorexiants; Antiobesity agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • A61P3/06Antihyperlipidemics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • A61P3/08Drugs for disorders of the metabolism for glucose homeostasis
    • A61P3/10Drugs for disorders of the metabolism for glucose homeostasis for hyperglycaemia, e.g. antidiabetics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P5/00Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system
    • A61P5/48Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system of the pancreatic hormones
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P5/00Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system
    • A61P5/48Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system of the pancreatic hormones
    • A61P5/50Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system of the pancreatic hormones for increasing or potentiating the activity of insulin
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D403/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00
    • C07D403/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00 containing two hetero rings
    • C07D403/12Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00 containing two hetero rings linked by a chain containing hetero atoms as chain links
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D403/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00
    • C07D403/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D401/00 containing three or more hetero rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D411/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having oxygen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms
    • C07D411/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having oxygen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms containing three or more hetero rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D413/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms
    • C07D413/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and oxygen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms containing three or more hetero rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D417/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00
    • C07D417/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00 containing three or more hetero rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D419/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms
    • C07D419/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms containing three or more hetero rings

Definitions

  • the present invention relates to a group of benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds which may be useful in the treatment or prevention of a disease or medical condition mediated through glucokinase (GLK or GK), leading to a decreased glucose threshold for insulin secretion.
  • GLK or GK glucokinase
  • the compounds are predicted to lower blood glucose by increasing hepatic glucose uptake.
  • Such compounds may have utility in the treatment of Type 2 diabetes and obesity.
  • the invention also relates to pharmaceutical compositions comprising said compounds and to methods of treatment of diseases mediated by GLK using said compounds.
  • the main plasma membrane glucose transporter is GLUT2.
  • GLK glucose-6-phosphate
  • GLK glucokinase
  • GLK activity is rate limiting for glucose utilisation and therefore regulates the extent of glucose induced insulin secretion and hepatic glycogen synthesis. These processes are critical in the maintenance of whole body glucose homeostasis and both are dysfunctional in diabetes [2].
  • Maturity-Onset Diabetes of the Young Type 2 (MODY- 2)
  • the diabetes is caused by GLK loss of function mutations [3, 4].
  • Hyperglycaemia in MODY-2 patients results from defective glucose utilisation in both the pancreas and liver [5].
  • Defective glucose utilisation in the pancreas of MODY-2 patients results in a raised threshold for glucose stimulated insulin secretion.
  • rare activating mutations of GLK reduce this threshold resulting in familial hyperinsulinism [6, 6a, 7].
  • hepatic glucokinase activity is also decreased in type 2 diabetics [8].
  • GLK global or liver selective overexpression of GLK prevents or reverses the development of the diabetic phenotype in both dietary and genetic models of the disease [9-12].
  • acute treatment of type 2 diabetics with fructose improves glucose tolerance through stimulation of hepatic glucose utilisation [13]. This effect is believed to be mediated through a fructose induced increase in cytosolic GLK activity in the hepatocyte by the mechanism described below [13].
  • GLK regulatory protein GLK regulatory protein
  • F6P fructose-6-phosphate
  • FlP fructose- 1 -phosphate
  • F6P fructose-6-phosphate
  • FlP is generated by fructokinase mediated phosphorylation of dietary fructose. Consequently, GLK/GLKRP complex integrity and hepatic GLK activity is regulated in a nutritionally dependent manner as F6P is dominant in the post-absorptive state whereas FlP predominates in the post-prandial state.
  • the pancreatic ⁇ -cell expresses GLK in the absence of GLKRP. Therefore, ⁇ -cell GLK activity is regulated extensively by the availability of its substrate, glucose. Small molecules may activate GLK either directly or through destabilising the GLK/GLKRP complex.
  • the former class of compounds are predicted to stimulate glucose utilisation in both the liver and the pancreas whereas the latter are predicted to act selectively in the liver.
  • compounds with either profile are predicted to be of therapeutic benefit in treating Type 2 diabetes as this disease is characterised by defective glucose utilisation in both tissues.
  • GLK, GLKRP and the K ATP channel are expressed in neurones of the hypothalamus, a region of the brain that is important in the regulation of energy balance and the control of food intake [14-18]. These neurones have been shown to express orectic and anorectic neuropeptides [15, 19, 20] and have been assumed to be the glucose-sensing neurones within the hypothalamus that are either inhibited or excited by changes in ambient glucose concentrations [17, 19, 21, 22]. The ability of these neurones to sense changes in glucose levels is defective in a variety of genetic and experimentally induced models of obesity [23- 28].
  • Intracerebroventricular (icv) infusion of glucose analogues that are competitive inhibitors of glucokinase, stimulate food intake in lean rats [29, 30].
  • icv infusion of glucose suppresses feeding [31].
  • small molecule activators of GLK may decrease food intake and weight gain through central effects on GLK. Therefore, GLK activators may be of therapeutic use in treating eating disorders, including obesity, in addition to diabetes.
  • the hypothalamic effects will be additive or synergistic to the effects of the same compounds acting in the liver and/or pancreas in normalising glucose homeostasis, for the treatment of Type 2 diabetes.
  • GLK/GLKRP system can be described as a potential "Diabesity" target (of benefit in both Diabetes and Obesity).
  • GLK is also expressed in specific entero-endocrine cells where it is believed to control the glucose sensitive secretion of the incretin peptides GIP (glucose-dependent insulinotropic polypeptide) and GLP-I (Glucagon-Like Peptide- 1) from gut K-cells and L-cells respectively (32, 33, 34). Therefore, small molecule activators of GLK may have additional beneficial effects on insulin secretion, b-cell function and survival and body weight as a consequence of stimulating GIP and GLP-I secretion from these entero-endocrine cells.
  • glucokinase activators In WO00/58293 and WO01/44216 (Roche), a series of benzylcarbamoyl compounds are described as glucokinase activators. The mechanism by which such compounds activate GLK is assessed by measuring the direct effect of such compounds in an assay in which GLK activity is linked to NADH production, which in turn is measured optically - see details of the in vitro assay described hereinafter.
  • Compounds of the present invention may activate GLK directly or may activate GLK by inhibiting the interaction of GLKRP with GLK.
  • GLK activators have been described in WO03/095438 (substituted phenylacetamides, Roche), WO03/055482 (carboxamide and sulphonamide derivatives, Novo Nordisk), WO2004/002481 (arylcarbonyl derivatives, Novo Nordisk), and in WO03/080585 (amino-substituted benzoylaminoheterocycles, Banyu).
  • WO03/000267 describes a group of benzoyl amino pyridyl carboxylic acids which are activators of the enzyme glucokinase (GLK).
  • R 3 is a phenyl or a substituted heterocycle other than a carboxylic acid substituted pyridyl.
  • International application WO2004/076420 (Banyu) describes compounds which are generally a subset of those described in WO03/015774, wherein for example R 1 is an (substituted) alkyl ether and R 2 is (substituted) phenoxy.
  • the compounds of the invention may have favourable metabolic profiles and/or toxicity profiles.
  • the compounds of the invention may also have superior potency and/or advantageous physical properties (as described above) and/or favourable toxicity profiles and/or favourable metabolic profiles in comparison with other GLK activators known in the art, as well as those described in WO 03/015774.
  • R 1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
  • HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 6 ;
  • Ring A is selected from phenyl, HET-2 and HET-3; wherein when Ring A is phenyl it is
  • R 2 is selected from -C(O)NR 4 R 5 , SOpR 4 , and -SO 2 NR 4 R 5 ;
  • R 3 is selected from halo, methyl and trifluoromethyl;
  • R 4 is selected from hydrogen, (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from HET-5, -OR 5 , -SO 2 R 5 , (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R 15 ) and -C(O)NR 5 R 5 ], (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R 15 ) and HET-5;
  • HET-5 is a 4-, 5- or 6-membered, C- or N-linked heterocyclyl ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH 2 - group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- , and wherein a sulphur atom in the heterocyclic ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O) 2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon or nitrogen atom by 1 or 2 (l-4C)alkyl substituents; R 5 is hydrogen or (l-4C)alkyl; or R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH 2 - group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)
  • R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 6-10 membered bicyclic saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 further nitrogen atom (in addition to the linking N atom), wherein a -CH 2 - group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)-; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon by 1 substituent selected from hydroxy, methyl and halo, or on an available nitrogen atom by methyl;
  • R 6 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l- 4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di( 1 -4C)alkylamino(l -4C)alkyl;
  • R 7 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l- 4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl;
  • R 8 is selected from hydroxy, (l-4C)al
  • R 9 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1- 4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, di(l-4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-
  • HET-2 is a 5- or 6- membered heteroaryl ring, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N; which ring is substituted on an available carbon atom by a substituent selected from R 2 , and is optionally further substituted on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 3 and/or on an available nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quatemised) by a substituent selected from R 10 ;
  • R 10 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
  • HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system of formula -B-C; wherein B is a Ring is directly attached to the linking oxygen atom and Ring B is phenyl or is a 5- or 6-membered heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or 3 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S (provided there are no 0-0, S-S or 0-S bonds in the ring); wherein Ring B is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from
  • R 11 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
  • R 12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l- 4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl, di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and HET-4;
  • HET-4 is a 5- or 6-membered, C-or N- linked unsubstituted heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or
  • Ring C is a 5-7 membered heterocyclic ring fused to Ring B, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N (provided that there are no 0-0, S-O or
  • R 13 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, benzyl, (l-4C)alkylcarbonyl, (1- 4C)alkylsulphonyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl;
  • R 14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy, hydroxy, fluoro and chloro;
  • R 15 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and hydroxy; n is 0 or 1 ; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2; or a salt thereof.
  • R 1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
  • HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 6 ;
  • Ring A is phenyl, substituted by R 2 and optionally further substituted by a group selected from R 3 ;
  • R 2 is selected from -C(O)NR 4 R 5 , SOpR 4 , and -SO 2 NR 4 R 5 ;
  • R 3 is selected from halo, methyl and trifluoromethyl;
  • R 4 is selected from hydrogen, (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from HET-5, -OR 5 , -SO 2 R 5 , (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R 15 ) and -C(O)NR 5 R 5 ], (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R 15 ) and HET-5;
  • HET-5 is a 4-, 5- or 6-membered, C- or N-linked heterocyclyl ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH 2 - group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- , and wherein a sulphur atom in the heterocyclic ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O) 2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon or nitrogen atom by 1 or 2 (l-4C)alkyl substituents; R 5 is hydrogen or (l-4C)alkyl; or R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH 2 - group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)
  • R 6 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l- 4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl;
  • R 7 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l- 4C)alkylamino( 1 -4C)alkyl;
  • R 15 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and hydroxy; n is 0 or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2; or a salt thereof.
  • R 1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
  • HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 6 ;
  • Ring A is HET-2;
  • HET-2 is a 5- or 6- membered heteroaryl ring, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N; which ring is substituted on an available carbon atom by a substituent selected from R 2 , and is optionally further substituted on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 3 and/or on an available nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 10 ;
  • R 2 is selected from -C(O)NR 4 R 5 , SOpR 4 , and -SO 2 NR 4 R 5 ;
  • R 3 is selected from halo, methyl and trifluoromethyl
  • R 4 is selected from hydrogen, (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from HET-5, -OR 5 , -SO 2 R 5 , (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R 15 ) and -C(O)NR 5 R 5 ], (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R 15 ) and HET-5
  • HET-5 is a 4-, 5- or 6-membered, C- or N-linked heterocyclyl ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH 2 - group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- , and wherein a sulphur atom in the heterocyclic ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O) 2 group; which ring is optionally substituted
  • R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH 2 - group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- and wherein a sulphur atom in the ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O) 2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R 8 and/or on an available nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R 9 ; or R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 6-10 membered bicyclic saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 further nitrogen atom (in addition to the linking N atom), wherein a -CH 2 - group can optionally be replaced by
  • R 7 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl,
  • R is selected from hydroxy, (l-4C)alkoxy, (l-4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1-
  • R 9 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1-
  • R 10 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3 ⁇ 6C)cycloalkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
  • R 15 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and hydroxy; n is O or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2; or a salt thereof.
  • R 1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
  • HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 6 ;
  • R 6 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
  • R 7 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl,
  • Ring A is HET-3; HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system of formula -B-C; wherein B is a ring directly attached to the linking oxygen atom and Ring B is phenyl or is a
  • R 11 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
  • R 12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
  • HET-4 is a 5- or 6-membered, C-or N- linked unsubstituted heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or
  • Ring C is a 5-7 membered heterocyclic ring fused to Ring B, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N (provided that there are no 0-0, S-O or
  • R 13 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, benzyl, (l-4C)alkylcarbonyl, (1-
  • R 14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy, hydroxy, fluoro and chloro; n is O or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2; or a salt thereof.
  • Reference hereinafter to a compound of formula (I) should be understood to apply equally to compounds of formula (II), (III) or (IV), even where not explicitly stated.
  • heterocyclyl group HET-I encompass heteroaryl rings which may be substituted on nitrogen, such substitution may not result in charged quaternary nitrogen atoms, removal of aromaticity of the ring or unstable structures. It will be appreciated that the definition of HET-I is not intended to include any O- O, O-S or S-S bonds. It will be appreciated that the definition of HET-I is not intended to include unstable structures.
  • any single carbon atom in HET-I may only be substituted by one group R 6 in order to maintain aromaticity of the ring.
  • Up to two different carbon atoms in a HET-I ring may be substituted by an R 6 group, each of which may be the same or different, provided the structure thereby formed is stable and aromatic.
  • R 8 can be present on any or all available carbon atoms in the heterocyclic ring formed by NR 4 R 5 ; each carbon atom can be substituted with 1 or 2 R 8 groups which may be the same or different, provided the structure thereby formed is stable (so, for example, it is not intended to cover gem-dihydroxy substitution).
  • Compounds of Formula (I) may form salts which are within the ambit of the invention.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are preferred although other salts may be useful in, for example, isolating or purifying compounds.
  • the invention relates to compounds of formula (I) as hereinabove defined or to a pharmaceutically acceptable salt.
  • the invention relates to compounds of formula (I) as hereinabove defined or to a pro-drug thereof.
  • Suitable examples of pro-drugs of compounds of formula (I) are in- vivo hydroly sable esters of compounds of formula (I). Therefore in another aspect, the invention relates to compounds of formula (I) as hereinabove defined or to an in- vivo hydrolysable ester thereof.
  • the generic term "alkyl” includes both straight-chain and branched-chain alkyl groups. However references to individual alkyl groups such as "propyl” are specific for the straight chain version only and references to individual branched-chain alkyl groups such as ⁇ -butyl are specific for the branched chain version only. For example, "(l-4C)alkyl” includes methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl and ⁇ -butyl. An analogous convention applies to other generic terms.
  • HET-I containing a nitrogen in the 2-position
  • HET-I encompasses but is not limited to the heterocycles shown in the following structures:
  • HET-I as a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring as hereinbefore defined, include thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrimidinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl and triazolyl.
  • HET-2 examples include thienyl, furyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrimidinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl and triazolyl.
  • Further suitable examples of HET-2 include aromatic heterocycles where a ring nitrogen or sulfur atom has been oxidised but aromaticity has been preserved, for example a pyridine N-oxide.
  • Further suitable examples of HET-2 include thiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl and pyrimidinyl.
  • Suitable examples for a 4-7 membered ring formed by R 4 and R 5 together with the ' nitrogen to which they are attached include morpholino, thiomorpholino (and versions thereof wherein the sulfur is oxidised to an SO or S(O) 2 group), piperidinyl, piperazinyl, pyrrolidinyl, azetidinyl, homopiperazinyl, homo-morpholino, homo- thiomorpholino (and versions thereof wherein the sulfur is oxidised to an SO or S(O) 2 group) and homo-piperidinyl.
  • Suitable examples for a 6-10 membered bicyclic heterocyclic ring formed by R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen to which they are attached, as hereinbefore defined, are bicyclic saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring such as those illustrated by the structures shown below (wherein the dotted line indicates the point of attachment to the rest of the molecule and wherein R represents the optional substituents on carbon or nitrogen defined hereinbefore):
  • such a ring system is a [2,2,1] system such as (7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]hept-7-yl).
  • such a ring system is a [2.1.1] system such as
  • Suitable values for the bicyclic system HET-3 formed by ring B fused to Ring C include those where Ring C is pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyrimidinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, homopiperazinyl, morpholinyl, homomorpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, homothiomorpholinyl, oxathianyl, homooxathianyl, furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, imidazolyl, imidazolidinyl, pyrazolyl, isoxazolyl, isothiazolyl, pyranyl, 1 ,A- dioxolanyl, dihydrothienyl, dihydrofuryl and oxathiazepinyl. Further suitable values include those wherein Ring C is oxathiaze
  • Ring C have been oxidised to a carbonyl group
  • sulfur atoms in Ring C have been oxidised to an S(O) or S(O) 2 group.
  • Ring B as a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclyl ring are furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, isoxazolyl, isothiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyrimidinyl and pyridazinyl.
  • Further suitable vaues for Ring B are thiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyrimidinyl and pyridazinyl.
  • Still further suitable values for Ring B are thiazolyl and pyridyl.
  • Ring B is phenyl.
  • HET-3 may suitably be selected from the structures below (which may optionally be substituted as hereinbefore defined):
  • suitable values for HET-3 are ring systems where Ring C is a 7- membered ring, for example:
  • HET-3 includes the following formulae A to F, wherein each R 12a is independently hydrogen or is R 12 as hereinbefore defined, each R 13a is independently hydrogen or is R 13 as hereinbefore defined, each R 14a is independently hydrogen or is R 14 as hereinbefore defined:
  • HET-3 Further suitable values for HET-3 include formulae G to P as follows:
  • Ring C as 1,3-dioxolyl are intended to refer to structures such as the following (illustrated with Ring B is phenyl):
  • Ring C as 1,4-dioxolanyl are intended to refer to structures such as the following (illustrated with Ring B is phenyl):
  • suitable values for the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl include the following (wherein each R 13a is hydrogen or is selected from R 13 as hereinbefore defined, R 14a is hydrogen or is selected from R 14 as hereinbefore defined and each R 12a is hydrogen or is R 12 as hereinbefore defined):
  • the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is selected from formulae AA to MM (wherein R 12a is hydrogen or is selected from R 12 as hereinbefore defined, R 13a is hydrogen or is selected from R 13 as hereinbefore defined and each R 14a is hydrogen or R 14 as hereinbefore defined):
  • the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is selected from:
  • R 13a is hydrogen or is methyl and R 12a is hydrogen or is R 12 as hereinbefore defined, for example R 12a is hydrogen or fluoro, or for example R 12a is hydrogen.
  • the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is selected from
  • R 14a are hydrogen
  • R 13a is hydrogen or is methyl
  • R l2a is hydrogen or is R 12 as hereinbefore defined, for example R 12a is hydrogen or fluoro, or for example R 12a is hydrogen.
  • the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is of formula EE.
  • the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is of formula FF.
  • the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is of formula GG.
  • the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is of formula HH.
  • the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is of formula (Z):
  • Ring C is an optionally substituted 5-7 membered heterocyclic ring fused to the benzene ring, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N (provided that there are no 0-0, S-O or S-S bonds within the ring), wherein any ring carbon or sulfur atom may optionally be oxidised, provided that where Ring C contains two ring heteroatoms they are not both oxygen (such that for example, Ring C is not dioxolyl or dioxolanyl).
  • HET-4 examples include thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrimidinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl and triazolyl.
  • HET-5 can be a saturated, or partially or fully unsaturated ring.
  • HET-5 examples include azetidinyl, furyl, thienyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrimidinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, morpholino, morpholinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, pyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, pyrrolidonyl, 2,5-dioxopyrrolidinyl, 1,1- dioxotetrahydrothienyl, 2-oxoimidazolidinyl, 2,4-dioxoimidazolidinyl, 2-oxo-l,3,4-(4- triazolinyl), 2-oxazolidin
  • HET-5 may be linked by any appropriate available C or N atom, therefore for example, for HET-5 as "imidazolyl” includes 1- , 2-, 4- and 5- imidazolyl.
  • Examples of (l-4C)alkyl include methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl and tert-butyl; examples of (3-6C)cycloalkyl include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl and cyclohexyl; examples of halo include fluoro, chloro, bromo and iodo; examples of hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl include hydroxymethyl, 1-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxypropyl, 3-hydroxypropyl, 1-hydroxyisopropyl and 4-hydroxybutyl; examples of (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl include methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, tert-butoxymethyl, 2-me
  • the invention includes in its definition any such optically active or racemic form which possesses the property of stimulating GLK directly or inhibiting the GLK/GLKRP interaction.
  • the synthesis of optically active forms may be carried out by standard techniques of organic chemistry well known in the art, for example by synthesis from optically active starting materials or by resolution of a racemic form.
  • certain compounds may exist in tautomeric forms and that the invention also relates to any and all tautomeric forms of the compounds of the invention which activate GLK.
  • the compound of formula (I) has the (S)-configuration at the pyrrolidone ring and is thereby a compound of formula (IA):
  • the compound of formula (I) has the (Reconfiguration at the pyrrolidone ring and is thereby a compound of formula (IB):
  • compounds of formula (I) and salts thereof can exist in solvated as well as unsolvated forms such as, for example, hydrated forms. It is to be understood that the invention encompasses all such solvated forms which activate GLK.
  • compounds of formula (I) in an alternative embodiment are provided pharmaceutically-acceptable salts of compounds of formula (I), in a further alternative embodiment are provided in- vivo hydrolysable esters of compounds of formula (I), and in a further alternative embodiment are provided pharmaceutically-acceptable salts of in-vivo hydrolysable esters of compounds of formula (I).
  • Preferred values of each variable group are as follows.
  • R 1 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 1 is methyl or ethyl
  • R 1 is (3-6C)acycloalkyl, such as cyclobutyl (4) R 1 is methyl, ethyl or cyclobutyl
  • HET-I is a 5-membered heteroaryl ring
  • HET-I is a 6-membered heteroaryl ring
  • HET-I is substituted with 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R 6
  • HET-I is substituted with 1 substituent selected from R 6 (9) HET-I is substituted with 1 substituent selected from R 7
  • HET-I is unsubstituted (11)
  • HET-I is selected from thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrimidinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, and triazolyl
  • HET-I is selected from thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl and oxadiazolyl
  • HET-I is pyrazolyl, optionally substituted with a methyl group on an available carbon
  • HET-I is pyrazinyl, optionally substituted with a methyl group on an available carbon atom
  • HET-I is thiazolyl, optionally substituted with a methyl group on an available carbon atom
  • HET-I is pyrazinyl, pyrazolyl or thiazolyl, optionally substituted with a methyl group on an available carbon atom
  • R 6 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and di(l-4C)alkylamino(l- 4C)alkyl (18) R 6 is selected from methyl, ethyl, bromo, chloro, fluoro, hydroxymethyl, methoxymethyl, aminomethyl, N-methylaminomethyl, dimethylaminomethyl
  • R 6 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, (1-
  • R 6 is selected from methyl, ethyl, bromo, chloro, fluoro, hydroxymethyl and methoxymethyl
  • R 6 is selected from methyl, ethyl, chloro and fluoro
  • R 7 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl (24) R 7 is selected from methyl, ethyl, hydroxymethyl, methoxymethyl, aminomethyl, N-methylaminomethyl, dimethylaminomethyl
  • R 7 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, (1- 4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl, and di(l- 4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl (26) R 7 is selected from methyl, ethyl, aminomethyl, N-methylaminomethyl, and dimethylaminomethyl (27) R 7 is selected from methyl, ethyl, hydroxymethyl and methoxymethyl (28) R 7 is selected from methyl and ethyl
  • R 7 is methyl
  • Ring A is phenyl (31) Ring A is HET-2 (32) Ring A is HET-3
  • R 3 is chloro or fluoro
  • R 3 is fluoro
  • R 2 is -C(O)NR 4 R 5 (37) R 2 is -SO 2 NR 4 R 5
  • R 2 is SOpR 4
  • R 2 is -C(O)NR 4 R 5 or SO P R 4
  • R 4 is selected from hydrogen, optionally substituted (l-4C)alkyl and optionally substituted (3-6C)cycloalkyl (41)
  • R 4 is (l-4C)alkyl, such as methyl
  • R 5 is (l-4C)alkyl, such as methyl
  • R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a ring selected from morpholino, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, pyrrolidinyl and azetidinyl (50) R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form an azetidinyl ring (5I) R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form an unsubstituted ring
  • R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a ring mono- substituted either with a substituent R 8 or with a substituent R 9 (53) R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 6-10 membered bicyclic saturated or partially unsaturated ring
  • R 8 is selected from hydroxy, (l-4C)alkoxy, (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 8 is selected from hydroxy, methoxy and methyl
  • R 9 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl (57)
  • R 2 is azetidinylcarbonyl
  • HET-2 is a 5-membered heteroaryl ring
  • HET-2 is a 6-membere heteroaryl ring
  • HET-2 is selected from pyrazinyl and pyridyl
  • HET-2 is substituted with a substituent selected from R 3 (62) HET-2 has one nitrogen substituent selected from R 10
  • R 10 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 10 is (3-6C)cycloalkyl
  • R 10 is hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl or (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl
  • R 10 is -C(O)(l-4C)alkyl
  • R 10 is benzyl
  • R 10 is (l-4C)alkylsulfonyl
  • Ring B is 5- or 6-membered heteroaryl ring
  • Ring B is phenyl or a 6-membered heteroaryl ring
  • Ring B is a 5-membered heteroaryl ring
  • Ring B is a 6-membered heteroaryl ring
  • Ring C is a 5-membered ring
  • Ring C is a 6-membered ring
  • Ring C is a 7-membered ring (80) Ring C is unsubstituted
  • Ring C is substituted on an available nitrogen atom by R 13
  • Ring C is substituted on each available nitrogen atom by a substituent R 13 , wherein each R 13 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl and benzyl (83) Ring C is substituted on an available carbon atom by R 14
  • Ring C is substituted on more than one available carbon atom by substituents independently selected from R 14
  • Ring C is substituted on one or more available carbon atom by methyl, and/or twice on one carbon atom by methyl (86)
  • Ring B is heteroaryl and Ring C is phenyl
  • Ring B is heteroaryl and Ring C is heterocyclyl
  • HET-3 is a 5,6 fused bicyclic system
  • HET-3 is a 5,5 fused bicyclic system
  • HET-3 is a 6,6 fused bicyclic system (91) HET-3 is a 5 ,7 fused bicyclic system
  • HET-3 is a 6,7 fused bicyclic system
  • HET-3 is selected from structures A to F as hereinbefore defined, particularly wherein R 13 and R 14 are both methyl and R 12 is chloro or fluoro
  • HET-3 is selected from structures G to P as hereinbefore defined (95) Ring C is substituted by two R 14 and both are either methyl or fluoro
  • Ring C is gem di-substituted by R 14 and both are either methyl or fluoro
  • R 12 is chloro (100) R 12 is hydrogen or fluoro
  • HET-3 is selected from structures AA to MM as hereinbefore defined
  • HET-3 is selected from structures EE, FF, GG and HH
  • HET-3 is selected from structures EE, FF and GG
  • R 1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl
  • HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 6 ;
  • Ring A is selected from phenyl, HET-2 and HET-3; wherein when Ring A is phenyl it is substituted by R 2 and optionally further substituted by a group selected from R 3 ;
  • R 2 is selected from -C(O)NR 4 R 5 , SOpR 4 , and -SO 2 NR 4 R 5 ;
  • R 3 is selected from halo, methyl and trifluoromethyl;
  • R 4 is selected from hydrogen and (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by a substituent selected from -OR 5 and -C(O)NR 5 R 5 ];
  • R 5 is hydrogen or (l-4C)alkyl; or R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH 2 - group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- and wherein a sulphur atom in the ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O) 2 group;
  • R 6 is (l-4C)alkyl;
  • R 7 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • HET-2 is a 5- or 6- membered heteroaryl ring, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N; which ring is substituted on an available carbon atom by a substituent selected from R 2 , and is optionally further substituted on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 3 and/or on an available nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 10 ;
  • R 10 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system of formula -B-C; wherein B is a Ring is directly attached to the linking oxygen atom and Ring B is phenyl or is a 5- or 6-membered heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or 3 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S (provided there are no 0-0, S-S or 0-S bonds in the ring); wherein Ring B is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R 11 and/or on any available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from
  • R n is (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl and halo
  • Ring C is a 5-7 membered heterocyclic ring fused to Ring B, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N (provided that there are no 0-0, S-O or
  • R 13 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, fluoro and chloro; n is 0 or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2.
  • R 1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
  • HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 6 ; Ring A is phenyl, substituted by R 2 and optionally further substituted by a group selected
  • R 2 is selected from -C(O)NR 4 R 5 , SOpR 4 and -SO 2 NR 4 R 5 ;
  • R 3 is halo
  • R 4 is selected from hydrogen and (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by a substituent selected from -OR 5 and -C(O)NR 5 R 5 ] ;
  • R 5 is hydrogen or (l-4C)alkyl; or R 4 and R 5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH 2 - group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- and wherein a sulphur atom in the ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O) 2 group;
  • R 6 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 7 is (l-4C)alkyl; n is 0 or 1 ; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2.
  • R 1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
  • HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 6 ;
  • Ring A is HET-3;
  • HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system selected from formulae A to P as hereinbefore defined;
  • R 12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl and halo
  • R 13 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, fluoro and chloro;
  • R 6 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 7 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • n is 0 or 1
  • p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2.
  • R 1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
  • HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 6 ; Ring A is HET-3;
  • HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system selected from formulae AA to MM as hereinbefore defined;
  • R 12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl and halo
  • R 13 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, fiuoro and chloro
  • R 6 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 7 is (l-4C)alkyl; n is 0 or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2.
  • R 1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
  • HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R 7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R 6 ;
  • Ring A is HET-3;
  • HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system selected from formulae EE, FF, GG and HH as hereinbefore defined;
  • R 12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl and halo
  • R 13 is (l-4C)alkyl
  • R 14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, fiuoro and chloro; R 6 is (l-4C)alkyl;
  • R 7 is (l-4C)alkyl; n is 0 or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2.
  • N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide 3-[6-(Azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)- 1 -ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
  • a pro-drug is a bioprecursor or pharmaceutically acceptable compound being degradable in the body to produce a compound of the invention (such as an ester or amide of a compound of the invention, particularly an in- vivo hydroly sable ester).
  • a compound of the invention such as an ester or amide of a compound of the invention, particularly an in- vivo hydroly sable ester.
  • Various forms of prodrugs are known in the art.
  • pro-drags are as follows.
  • An in- vivo hydrolysable ester of a compound of the invention containing a carboxy or a hydroxy group is, for example, a pharmaceutically- acceptable ester which is hydrolysed in the human or animal body to produce the parent acid or alcohol.
  • Suitable pharmaceutically-acceptable esters for carboxy include
  • C 1 to Cgalkoxymethyl esters for example methoxymethyl
  • C 1 to C ealkanoyloxymethyl esters for example pivaloyloxymethyl
  • phthalidyl esters C 3 to CgcycloalkoxycarbonyloxyC] to C 6 alkyl esters for example
  • An in- vivo hydrolysable ester of a compound of the invention containing a hydroxy group includes inorganic esters such as phosphate esters (including phosphoramidic cyclic esters) and ⁇ -acyloxyalkyl ethers and related compounds which as a result of the in- vivo hydrolysis of the ester breakdown to give the parent hydroxy group/s.
  • inorganic esters such as phosphate esters (including phosphoramidic cyclic esters) and ⁇ -acyloxyalkyl ethers and related compounds which as a result of the in- vivo hydrolysis of the ester breakdown to give the parent hydroxy group/s.
  • ⁇ -acyloxyalkyl ethers include acetoxymethoxy and 2,2-dimethylpropionyloxy-methoxy.
  • a selection of in- vivo hydrolysable ester forming groups for hydroxy include alkanoyl, benzoyl, phenylacetyl and substituted benzoyl and phenylacetyl, alkoxycarbonyl (to give alkyl carbonate esters), dialkylcarbamoyl and N-(dialkylaminoethyl)-N-alkylcarbamoyl (to give carbamates), dialkylaminoacetyl and carboxyacetyl.
  • compounds of Formula (I) may form pharmaceutically acceptable salts.
  • a suitable pharmaceutically-acceptable salt of a compound of the invention is, for example, an acid-addition salt of a compound of the invention which is sufficiently basic, for example, an acid-addition salt with, for example, an inorganic or organic acid, for example hydrochloric, hydrobromic, sulphuric, phosphoric, trifluoroacetic, citric or maleic acid.
  • a suitable pharmaceutically acceptable salt of a compound of the invention which is sufficiently acidic is an alkali metal salt, for example a sodium or potassium salt, an alkaline earth metal salt, for example a calcium or magnesium salt, an ammonium salt or a salt with an organic base which affords a physiologically-acceptable cation, for example a salt with methylamine, dimethylamine, trimethylamine, piperidine, morpholine or tris-(2-hydroxyethyl)amine.
  • an alkali metal salt for example a sodium or potassium salt
  • an alkaline earth metal salt for example a calcium or magnesium salt
  • an ammonium salt or a salt with an organic base which affords a physiologically-acceptable cation
  • a salt with methylamine, dimethylamine, trimethylamine, piperidine, morpholine or tris-(2-hydroxyethyl)amine for example a salt with methylamine, dimethylamine, trimethylamine, piperidine, morpholine or tris-(2-hydroxye
  • a further feature of the invention is a pharmaceutical composition
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of Formula (I) as defined above, or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, together with a pharmaceutically-acceptable diluent or carrier.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof as defined above for use as a medicament for treatment of a disease mediated through GLK, in particular type 2 diabetes.
  • a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof in the preparation of a medicament for treatment of a disease mediated through GLK, in particular type 2 diabetes.
  • the compound is suitably formulated as a pharmaceutical composition for use in this way.
  • a method of treating GLK mediated diseases, especially diabetes by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, to a mammal in need of such treatment.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof for treatment of a disease mediated through GLK.
  • Specific diseases which may be treated by a compound or composition of the invention include: blood glucose lowering in Type 2 Diabetes Mellitus without a serious risk of hypoglycaemia (and potential to treat type 1), dyslipidemia, obesity, insulin resistance, metabolic syndrome X, impaired glucose tolerance.
  • the GLK/GLKRP system can be described as a potential "Diabesity" target (of benefit in both Diabetes and Obesity).
  • a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof in the preparation of a medicament for use in the combined treatment or prevention, particularly treatment, of diabetes and obesity.
  • a method for the combined treatment of obesity and diabetes by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, to a mammal in need of such treatment.
  • a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof as defined above for use as a medicament for treatment or prevention, particularly treatment of obesity.
  • a method for the treatment of obesity by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, to a mammal in need of such treatment.
  • compositions of the invention may be particularly suitable for use as pharmaceuticals because of advantageous physical and/or pharmacokinetic properties, and/or favourable toxicity profile.
  • the compositions of the invention may be in a form suitable for oral use (for example as tablets, lozenges, hard or soft capsules, aqueous or oily suspensions, emulsions, dispersible powders or granules, syrups or elixirs), for topical use (for example as creams, ointments, gels, or aqueous or oily solutions or suspensions), for administration by inhalation (for example as a finely divided powder or a liquid aerosol), for administration by insufflation (for example as a finely divided powder) or for parenteral administration (for example as a sterile aqueous or oily solution for intravenous, subcutaneous, intramuscular or intramuscular dosing or as a suppository for rectal dosing). Dosage forms suitable for oral use are preferred.
  • compositions of the invention may be obtained by conventional procedures using conventional pharmaceutical excipients, well known in the art.
  • compositions intended for oral use may contain, for example, one or more colouring, sweetening, flavouring and/or preservative agents.
  • Suitable pharmaceutically acceptable excipients for a tablet formulation include, for example, inert diluents such as lactose, sodium carbonate, calcium phosphate or calcium carbonate, granulating and disintegrating agents such as corn starch or algenic acid; binding agents such as starch; lubricating agents such as magnesium stearate, stearic acid or talc; preservative agents such as ethyl or propyl rj-hydroxybenzoate, and anti-oxidants, such as ascorbic acid.
  • Tablet formulations may be uncoated or coated either to modify their disintegration and the subsequent absorption of the active ingredient within the gastrointestinal tract, or to improve their stability and/or appearance, in either case, using conventional coating agents and procedures well known in the art.
  • Compositions for oral use may be in the form of hard gelatin capsules in which the active ingredient is mixed with an inert solid diluent, for example, calcium carbonate, calcium phosphate or kaolin, or as soft gelatin capsules in which the active ingredient is mixed with water or an oil such as peanut oil, liquid paraffin, or olive oil.
  • an inert solid diluent for example, calcium carbonate, calcium phosphate or kaolin
  • water or an oil such as peanut oil, liquid paraffin, or olive oil.
  • Aqueous suspensions generally contain the active ingredient in finely powdered form together with one or more suspending agents, such as sodium carboxymethylcellulose, methylcellulose, hydroxypropylmethylcellulose, sodium alginate, polyvinyl-pyrrolidone, gum tragacanth and gum acacia; dispersing or wetting agents such as lecithin or condensation products of an alkylene oxide with fatty acids (for example polyoxethylene stearate), or condensation products of ethylene oxide with long chain aliphatic alcohols, for example heptadecaethyleneoxycetanol, or condensation products of ethylene oxide with partial esters derived from fatty acids and a hexitol such as polyoxyethylene sorbitol monooleate, or condensation products of ethylene oxide with long chain aliphatic alcohols, for example heptadecaethyleneoxycetanol, or condensation products of ethylene oxide with partial esters derived from fatty acids and a hexitol such as polyoxyethylene sorbitol
  • the aqueous suspensions may also contain one or more preservatives (such as ethyl or propyl p_-hydroxybenzoate, antioxidants (such as ascorbic acid), colouring agents, flavouring agents, and/or sweetening agents (such as sucrose, saccharine or aspartame).
  • Oily suspensions may be formulated by suspending the active ingredient in a vegetable oil (such as arachis oil, olive oil, sesame oil or coconut oil) or in a mineral oil (such as liquid paraffin).
  • the oily suspensions may also contain a thickening agent such as beeswax, hard paraffin or cetyl alcohol. Sweetening agents such as those set out above, and flavouring agents may be added to provide a palatable oral preparation. These compositions may be preserved by the addition of an anti-oxidant such as ascorbic acid.
  • Dispersible powders and granules suitable for preparation of an aqueous suspension by the addition of water generally contain the active ingredient together with a dispersing or wetting agent, suspending agent and one or more preservatives. Suitable dispersing or wetting agents and suspending agents are exemplified by those already mentioned above. Additional excipients such as sweetening, flavouring and colouring agents, may also be present.
  • the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention may also be in the form of oil-in- water emulsions.
  • the oily phase may be a vegetable oil, such as olive oil or arachis oil, or a mineral oil, such as for example liquid paraffin or a mixture of any of these.
  • Suitable emulsifying agents may be, for example, naturally-occurring gums such as gum acacia or gum tragacanth, naturally-occurring phosphatides such as soya bean, lecithin, an esters or partial esters derived from fatty acids and hexitol anhydrides (for example sorbitan monooleate) and condensation products of the said partial esters with ethylene oxide such as polyoxyethylene sorbitan monooleate.
  • the emulsions may also contain sweetening, flavouring and preservative agents.
  • Syrups and elixirs may be formulated with sweetening agents such as glycerol, propylene glycol, sorbitol, aspartame or sucrose, and may also contain a demulcent, preservative, flavouring and/or colouring agent.
  • compositions may also be in the form of a sterile injectable aqueous or oily suspension, which may be formulated according to known procedures using one or more of the appropriate dispersing or wetting agents and suspending agents, which have been mentioned above.
  • a sterile injectable preparation may also be a sterile injectable solution or suspension in a non-toxic parenterally-acceptable diluent or solvent, for example a solution in 1,3-butanediol.
  • Compositions for administration by inhalation may be in the form of a conventional pressurised aerosol arranged to dispense the active ingredient either as an aerosol containing finely divided solid or liquid droplets.
  • Conventional aerosol propellants such as volatile fluorinated hydrocarbons or hydrocarbons may be used and the aerosol device is conveniently arranged to dispense a metered quantity of active ingredient.
  • Conventional aerosol propellants such as volatile fluorinated hydrocarbons or hydrocarbons may be used and the aerosol device is conveniently arranged to disp
  • the amount of active ingredient that is combined with one or more excipients to produce a single dosage form will necessarily vary depending upon the host treated and the particular route of administration.
  • a formulation intended for oral administration to humans will generally contain, for example, from 0.5 mg to 2 g of active agent compounded with an appropriate and convenient amount of excipients which may vary from about 5 to about 98 percent by weight of the total composition.
  • Dosage unit forms will generally contain about 1 mg to about 500 mg of an active ingredient.
  • the size of the dose for therapeutic or prophylactic purposes of a compound of the Formula (I) will naturally vary according to the nature and severity of the conditions, the age and sex of the animal or patient and the route of administration, according to well known principles of medicine.
  • a daily dose in the range for example, 0.5 mg to 75 mg per kg body weight is received, given if required in divided doses.
  • lower doses will be administered when a parenteral route is employed.
  • a dose in the range for example, 0.5 mg to 30 mg per kg body weight will generally be used.
  • a dose in the range for example, 0.5 mg to 25 mg per kg body weight will be used.
  • Oral administration is however preferred.
  • the elevation of GLK activity described herein may be applied as a sole therapy or in combination with one or more other substances and/or treatments for the indication being treated. Such conjoint treatment may be achieved by way of the simultaneous, sequential or separate administration of the individual components of the treatment. Simultaneous treatment may be in a single tablet or in separate tablets.
  • chemotherapy may include the following main categories of treatment: 1) Insulin and insulin analogues;
  • Insulin secretagogues including sulphonylureas (for example glibenclamide, glipizide), prandial glucose regulators (for example repaglinide, nateglinide);
  • Agents that improve incretin action for example dipeptidyl peptidase IV inhibitors, and GLP-I agonists);
  • Insulin sensitising agents including PPARgamma agonists (for example pioglitazone and rosiglitazone), and agents with combined PPARalpha and gamma activity;
  • Agents that modulate hepatic glucose balance for example metformin, fructose 1, 6 bisphosphatase inhibitors, glycogen phopsphorylase inhibitors, glycogen synthase kinase inhibitors
  • 6) Agents designed to reduce the absorption of glucose from the intestine for example acarbose
  • Agents designed to treat the complications of prolonged hyperglycaemia for example aldose reductase inhibitors
  • Anti-obesity agents for example sibutramine and orlistat
  • Anti- dyslipidaemia agents such as, HMG-CoA reductase inhibitors (eg statins); PP ARa agonists (fibrates, eg gemfibrozil); bile acid sequestrants (cholestyramine); cholesterol absorption inhibitors (plant stands, synthetic inhibitors); bile acid absorption inhibitors (IBATi) and nicotinic acid and analogues (niacin and slow release formulations);
  • Antihypertensive agents such as, ⁇ blockers (eg atenolol, inderal); ACE inhibitors (eg lisinopril); Calcium antagonists (eg. nifedipine); Angiotensin receptor antagonists (eg candesartan), ⁇ antagonists and diuretic agents (eg. furosemide, benzthiazide);
  • ⁇ blockers eg atenolol, inderal
  • ACE inhibitors eg lisinopril
  • Calcium antagonists eg. nifedipine
  • Angiotensin receptor antagonists eg candesartan
  • ⁇ antagonists and diuretic agents eg. furosemide, benzthiazide
  • Haemostasis modulators such as, antithrombotics, activators of fibrinolysis and antiplatelet agents; thrombin antagonists; factor Xa inhibitors; factor Vila inhibitors); antiplatelet agents (eg. aspirin, clopidogrel); anticoagulants (heparin and Low molecular weight analogues, hirudin) and warfarin; 13) Agents which antagonise the actions of glucagon; and
  • Anti-inflammatory agents such as non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs (eg. aspirin) and steroidal anti-inflammatory agents (eg. cortisone).
  • non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs eg. aspirin
  • steroidal anti-inflammatory agents eg. cortisone
  • a compound of the invention, or a salt thereof may be prepared by any process known to be applicable to the preparation of such compounds or structurally related compounds.
  • Functional groups may be protected and deprotected using conventional methods.
  • protecting groups such as amino and carboxylic acid protecting groups (as well as means of formation and eventual deprotection), see T. W. Greene and P.G.M. Wuts, "Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis", Second Edition, John Wiley & Sons, New York, 1991.
  • Processes for the synthesis of compounds of Formula (I) are provided as a further feature of the invention.
  • a process for the preparation of a compound of Formula (I) which comprises a process a) to g) (wherein the variables are as defined hereinbefore for compounds of Formula (I) unless otherwise defined): (a) reaction of an acid of Formula (V) or activated derivative thereof with a compound of Formula (VI);
  • Y 1 and Y 2 are 0-4 atom linkers, wherein each linker atom is independently selected from C, N, S or O (wherein any C or S can be optionally oxidised and any atom can be optionally substituted provided it is not quaternised and there are no S-S or 0-0 bonds), X 6 can be any nucleophilic species and X 7 a leaving group or vice versa; process (f) could also be accomplished using the intermediate ester Formula (XVII), followed by ester hydrolysis and amide formation by procedures described elsewhere and well known to those skilled in the art;
  • Suitable leaving groups X 1 to X 5 for processes b) to d) are any leaving group known in the art for these types of reactions, for example halo, alkoxy, trifluoromethanesulfonyloxy, methanesulfonyloxy, or p-toluenesulfonyloxy; or a group (such as a hydroxy group) that may be converted into a leaving group (such as an oxytriphenylphosphonium group) in situ.
  • Suitable values for R 1 containing a protected hydroxy group are any suitable protected hydroxy group known in the art, for example simple ethers such as a methyl ether, tert-butyl ether or silylethers such as -OSi[(l-4C)alkyl]3 (wherein each (l-4C)alkyl group is independently selected from methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, and tertbutyl).
  • Examples of such trialkylsilyl groups are trimethylsilyl, triethylsilyl, triisopropylsilyl and tert- butyldimethylsilyl.
  • Suitable values for hydroxy protecting groups are given hereinafter.
  • Compounds of Formulae (V) to (XIV) are commercially available, or are known in the art, or may be made by processes known in the art, for example as shown in the accompanying Examples, or as described below. For further information on processes for making such compounds, we refer to our PCT publications WO 03/000267, WO 03/015774 and WO 03/000262 and references therein. In general it will be appreciated that any aryl-0 or alkyl-O bond may be formed by nucleophilic substitution or metal catalysed processes, optionally in the presence of a suitable base.
  • Compounds of Formula (XV) may be made by processes such as those shown in processes a) to d) and/or by those processes mentioned above for compounds of formulae (V) to (XIV).
  • XVI may be made by reaction of suitable precursors with compounds of formula (VII) or derivatives thereof, for example, by nucleophilic displacement of a leaving group X 1 in a compound of formula (VII).
  • Compounds of formula (VII) are generally commercially available or maybe made by simple functional group interconversions from commercially available compounds, or by literature methods. Examples of approaches to the pyrrolidone group are outlined in Schemes 1 and 2 below and are further illustrated in the accompanying examples.
  • Step (i) proceeds according to the Mitsunobu reaction as is well known in the literature, more specifically, step (i) involves the reaction of a compound of Formula (VlII) with 3- hydroxyoxolan-2-one in the presence of triphenyl phosphine and DIAD, in a suitable solvent, for example anhydrous THF, and at a suitable temperature, for example 0 to 25°C, more suitably 20 to 25 0 C;
  • a suitable solvent for example anhydrous THF
  • a suitable temperature for example 0 to 25°C, more suitably 20 to 25 0 C;
  • Step (ii) involves the reaction of a compound of Formula (XVIII) with a suitable alcohol, for example ethanol, in the presence of a suitable base, for example potassium carbonate, and at a suitable temperature, for example 0 to 25°C, more suitably 20 to 25 0 C;
  • a suitable alcohol for example ethanol
  • a suitable base for example potassium carbonate
  • Step (iii) involves the reaction of a compound fo Formula (XIX) with methanesulfonyl chloride in the presenc of a suitable base, for example triethylamine, in a suitable solvent, for example DCM, and at a suitable temperature, for example 0 to 25 0 C, more suitably 20 to 25 0 C; and
  • a suitable base for example triethylamine
  • a suitable solvent for example DCM
  • Steps (iv) and (v) involve the reaction of a compound of Formula (XX) with a suitable metal iodide, such as sodium iodide, and a (l-4C)alkylamine or (3-6C)cycloalkylamine, in a suitable solvent, for example acetonitrile, and at a suitable temperature with heating in a microwave, for example 100 to 130 0 C, more suitably 115 to 125°C.
  • a suitable metal iodide such as sodium iodide
  • a (l-4C)alkylamine or (3-6C)cycloalkylamine for example acetonitrile
  • R 1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl.
  • Suitable reaction conditions for steps (i) and (ii) of Scheme 2 are as follows:
  • Step (i) involves the reaction of 2,4-dibromobutanoyl chloride with a (l-4C)alkylamine or (3-6C)cycloalkylamine in a suitable solvent, such as water and DCM, and at a suitable temperature, for example 0 to 50 0 C, more suitably 10 to 3O 0 C; and
  • a suitable solvent such as water and DCM
  • Step (ii) involves the reaction of a compound of Formula (XXIII) with a suitable base, for example sodium hydride, in a suitable solvent, for example THF, and at a suitable temperature, for example 0 to 30 0 C, more suitably 10 to 15°C.
  • a suitable base for example sodium hydride
  • THF a suitable solvent
  • a suitable temperature for example 0 to 30 0 C, more suitably 10 to 15°C.
  • substituents R 3 , R 6 and/or R 7 may be introduced into the molecule at any convenient point in the synthetic sequence or may be present in the starting materials.
  • a precursor to one of these substituents may be present in the molecule during the process steps a) to e) above, and then be transformed into the desired substituent as a final step to form the compound of formula (I); followed where necessary by i) converting a compound of Formula (I) into another compound of Formula (I); ii) removing any protecting groups; and/or iii) forming a salt thereof.
  • an appropriate coupling reaction such as a carbodiimide coupling reaction performed with EDAC (l-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride) in the presence of dimethylaminopyridine (DMAP) in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane (DCM), chloroform or dimethylformamide (DMF) at room temperature; or (ii) reaction in which the carboxylic group is activated to an acid chloride by reaction with a reagent known for such reactions such as l-chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine in the presence of a suitable solvent such as DCM.
  • EDAC l-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride
  • DMAP dimethylaminopyridine
  • DCM dichloromethane
  • DMF dimethylformamide
  • the acid chloride can then be reacted with a compound of Formula (VI) in the presence of a base, such as triethylamine or pyridine, in a suitable solvent such as chloroform or DCM at a temperature between O 0 C and 8O 0 C.
  • a base such as triethylamine or pyridine
  • a suitable solvent such as chloroform or DCM
  • Process b) - compounds of Formula (VII) and (VIII) can be reacted together in a suitable solvent, such as DMF or tetrahydrofuran (THF), with a base such as sodium hydride or potassium tert-butoxide, at a temperature in the range 0 to 200 0 C, optionally using microwave heating or metal catalysis such as palladium(H)acetate, palladium on carbon, copper(II)acetate or copper(I)iodide; alternatively, compounds of Formula (VII) and (VIII) can be reacted together in a suitable solvent, such as THF or DCM, with a suitable phosphine such as triphenylphosphine, and an azodicarboxylate such as diethylazodicarboxylate; process b) could also be carried out using a precursor to the ester of formula (IX) such as an aryl-nitrile or trifluoromethyl derivative, followed by conversion to a carboxylic acid
  • Process d) - reaction of a compound of Formula (XIII) with a compound of Formula (XIV) can be performed in a polar solvent, such as DMF or a non-polar solvent such as THF with a strong base, such as sodium hydride or potassium fert-butoxide at a temperature between 0 and 200 0 C, optionally using microwave heating or metal catalysis, such as palladium(II)acetate, palladium on carbon, copper(II)acetate or copper(I)iodide;
  • Process e) - coupling reactions of amino groups with carboxylic or sulfonic acids or acid derivatives to form an amide are well known in the art and are described above for Process a).
  • Process f) - cyclisations of a compound of formula (XVI) to a compound of formula (I) are well known in the art; for example, i) a coupling reaction of amino groups with carboxylic acids using coupling reagents or acid chlorides (see process a) to form amide bonds; ii) a coupling reaction of an amino group with a sulphonyl chloride in the presence of a suitable base, such as pyridine or triethylamine, in a suitable solvent such as DCM, toluene or pyridine at a temperature between O 0 C and 8O 0 C, to form a sulphonamide group; iii) reaction with a suitable solvent, such as DMF or tetrahydrofuran (THF), with a base such as sodium hydride or potassium tert-butoxide, at a temperature in the range 0 to 200 0 C, optionally using microwave heating or metal catalysis such as palladium(II)a
  • compounds of the Formula (XVI) may be made from compounds of Formula (XVII), wherein each R group is independently a simple substituent (such as halo or cyano) or hydrogen, by processes well known to those skilled in the art such as functional group interconversions (for example hydrolysis, hydrogenation, hydrogenolysis, oxidation or reduction), and/or further functionalisation by standard reactions (such as amide or sulphonamide or metal-catalysed coupling, or nucleophilic displacement or electrophilic substitution reactions); compounds of formula (XVII) may be made from commercially available materials by processes such as those described herein in processes a) to e).
  • each R group is independently a simple substituent (such as halo or cyano) or hydrogen
  • Ring C from a pre-cursor and form the phenoxy link in a one-pot reaction, so that it is unclear whether process c) or process e) is actually the final step.
  • Rearrangement of Ring C may also occur in some circumstances, for example it may occur in the following circumstances:
  • protecting groups are given below for the sake of convenience, in which "lower” signifies that the group to which it is applied preferably has 1-4 carbon atoms. It will be understood that these examples are not exhaustive. Where specific examples of methods for the removal of protecting groups are given below these are similarly not exhaustive. The use of protecting groups and methods of deprotection not specifically mentioned is of course within the scope of the invention.
  • a carboxy protecting group may be the residue of an ester-forming aliphatic or araliphatic alcohol or of an ester-forming silanol (the said alcohol or silanol preferably containing 1-20 carbon atoms).
  • carboxy protecting groups include straight or branched chain (l-12C)alkyl groups (e.g. isopropyl, t-butyl); lower alkoxy lower alkyl groups (e.g. methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, isobutoxymethyl); lower aliphatic acyloxy lower alkyl groups, (e.g. acetoxymethyl, propionyloxymethyl, butyryloxymethyl, pivaloyloxymethyl); lower alkoxycarbonyloxy lower alkyl groups (e.g. 1-methoxycarbonyloxy ethyl,
  • aryl lower alkyl groups e.g. ⁇ -methoxybenzyl, o-nitrobenzyl, p_-nitrobenzyl, benzhydryl and phthalidyl
  • tri(lower alkyl)silyl groups e.g. trimethylsilyl and t-butyldimethylsilyl
  • tri(lower alkyl)silyl lower alkyl groups e.g. trimethylsilylethyl
  • (2-6C)alkenyl groups e.g. allyl and vinylethyl.
  • hydroxy protecting groups include methyl, t-butyl, lower alkenyl groups (e.g. allyl); lower alkanoyl groups (e.g. acetyl); lower alkoxycarbonyl groups (e.g. t-butoxycarbonyl); lower alkenyloxycarbonyl groups (e.g. allyloxycarbonyl); aryl lower alkoxycarbonyl groups (e.g. benzoyloxycarbonyl, rj-methoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, o-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, rj-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl); tri lower alkyl/arylsilyl groups (e.g.
  • amino protecting groups include formyl, aralkyl groups (e.g. benzyl and substituted benzyl, e.g. D . -methoxybenzyl, nitrobenzyl and 2,4-dimethoxybenzyl, and triphenylmethyl); di-p_-anisylmethyl and furylmethyl groups; lower alkoxycarbonyl (e.g.
  • t-butoxycarbonyl lower alkenyloxycarbonyl (e.g. allyloxycarbonyl); aryl lower alkoxycarbonyl groups (e.g. benzyloxycarbonyl, p_-methoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, o-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, p_-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl; trialkylsilyl (e.g. trimethylsilyl and t-butyldimethylsilyl); alkylidene (e.g. methylidene); benzylidene and substituted benzylidene groups.
  • aryl lower alkoxycarbonyl groups e.g. benzyloxycarbonyl, p_-methoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, o-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, p_-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl
  • trialkylsilyl e.g. trimethylsilyl and t-butyldimethylsily
  • Methods appropriate for removal of hydroxy and amino protecting groups include, for example, hydrogenation, nucleophilic displacement, acid-, base, metal- or enzymically-catalysed hydrolysis, catalytic hydrogenolysis or photolytically for groups such as o-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, or with fluoride ions for silyl groups.
  • methylether protecting groups for hydroxy groups may be removed by trimethylsilyliodide.
  • a tert-butyl ether protecting group for a hydroxy group may be removed by hydrolysis, for example by use of hydrochloric acid in methanol.
  • protecting groups for amide groups include aralkoxymethyl (e.g. benzyloxymethyl and substituted benzyloxymethyl); alkoxymethyl (e.g. methoxymethyl and trimethylsilylethoxymethyl); tri alkyl/arylsilyl (e.g. trimethylsilyl, t-butyldimethylsily, t- butyldiphenylsilyl); tri alkyl/arylsilyloxymethyl (e.g. t-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl, t-butyldiphenylsilyloxymethyl); 4-alkoxyphenyl (e.g. 4-methoxyphenyl); 2,4- di(alkoxy)phenyl (e.g.
  • 2,4-dimethoxyphenyl 4-alkoxybenzyl (e.g. 4-methoxybenzyl); 2,4- di(alkoxy)benzyl (e.g. 2,4-di(methoxy)benzyl); and alk-1-enyl (e.g. allyl, but-1-enyl and substituted vinyl e.g. 2-phenylvinyl).
  • 4-alkoxybenzyl e.g. 4-methoxybenzyl
  • 2,4- di(alkoxy)benzyl e.g. 2,4-di(methoxy)benzyl
  • alk-1-enyl e.g. allyl, but-1-enyl and substituted vinyl e.g. 2-phenylvinyl
  • Aralkoxymethyl, groups may be introduced onto the amide group by reacting the latter group with the appropriate aralkoxymethyl chloride, and removed by catalytic hydrogenation.
  • Alkoxymethyl, tri alkyl/arylsilyl and tri alkyl/silyloxymethyl groups may be introduced by reacting the amide with the appropriate chloride and removing with acid; or in the case of the silyl containing groups, fluoride ions.
  • the alkoxyphenyl and alkoxybenzyl groups are conveniently introduced by arylation or alkylation with an appropriate halide and removed by oxidation with eerie ammonium nitrate.
  • alk-1-enyl groups may be introduced by reacting the amide with the appropriate aldehyde and removed with acid.
  • Example 8 S-M-tAzetidine-l-carbonyQphenoxyl-S-rDSVl-methyl- ⁇ -oxo-pyrrolidin-S- ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vDbenzamide
  • Example 11 3-f(5-methyl-6.,6-dioxo-2-oxa-6- ⁇ 6 -thia-5-azabicvclor5.4.01undeca-8,10 ⁇ 2- trien-10-yl)oxyl-5-(l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-vL)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yDbenzamide
  • Example 12 S-f ⁇ -fAzetidine-l-carbonvOpyridin-S-ylloxy-S-fOSVl-methyl-l-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-pyrazin-2-yl-benzamide
  • Example 13 3-f6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl ' )pyridin-3-ylloxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrroIidin-3-ylloxy-N-pyridin-2-yl-benzamide
  • Example 14 3-f(ll-Chloro-5-methyl-6-oxo-2-oxa-5-azabicvclof5.4.01undeca-8.10.12- trien-10-yl)oxyl-5-f(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- vDbenzamide
  • Example 20 3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyr)pyridin-3-yll oxy-5-r(3RVl-cvclobutyl-2-oxo- pyrro ⁇ din-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide
  • Example 22 -f6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-ylloxy-5-[(3R)-l-ethyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-yl
  • Example 25 3-f(2,2-Dioxo-6-oxa-2- ⁇ 6 -thiabicvclof5.4.01undeca-7,9,ll-trien-9-vnoxyl-5- [(3S " )-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(lH-pyrazol-3-yl)benzamide
  • Example 27 3-[(6,6-dioxo-2-oxa-6- ⁇ 6 -thia-5-azabicvclo[5.4.01undeca-8 ⁇ 0.12-trien-10- v ⁇ oxyl-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-v ⁇ benzamide
  • N 9 N- Dimethylacetamide was removed by evaporation under reduced pressure.
  • the residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate (30 mL) and water (50 mL).
  • the organic phase was separated and the aqueous layer was acidified with hydrochloric acid (IN, 5 mL) and extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 50 mL).
  • the combined organic extracts were washed with brine, dried (MgSO 4 ) and concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • the residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0-5% methanol in DCM to afford the product (120 mg, 40%).
  • Example 32 N.N-DimethvI-5-r3-rf3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-5-r(4-methyl- l,3-thiazol-2-vDcarbamoyl]phenoxylpyrazine-2-earboxamide
  • the DMA was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in water (200 mL), washed with ethyl acetate (3x50 mL), acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid and extracted with ethyl acetate (3 ⁇ 100 mL): The organic layer washed with water (2x20 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ) and the solvent removed under reduced pressure to afford the product (6.18 g, 76%).
  • 2,4-Dibromobutanoyl chloride (CAS no. 82820-87-9) (16.9 g, 64 mmol) in DCM (20 mL) was added dropwise to a solution of methylamine (20 mL) in water (30 mL) and DCM (30 mL) at 10-15°C, then warmed to 3O 0 C and stirred for 30 minutes. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous layer re-extracted with DCM (2x10 mL), the combined organic layers were washed with brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ) and evaporated to afford the product (16.3 g, 98%).
  • the residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0-100% ethyl acetate in hexane to give the racemic product (8.7 g).
  • the desired product was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using Merck 50mm 20 ⁇ m Chiralpak AS - No ASVOOSC JGOOl and ASVOOOSC BD004 columns in series, eluting with 30% ethylacetate in isohexane at a flow rate of 60 mL / min, using 9 separate injections of 70 mL of a 14 mg/ml solution of the racemate in ethanol (32 mL) and isohexane (38 mL) to afford the product (3.6 g, 41%) which eluted before its enantiomer.
  • Methyl 3-hydroxy-5-phenylmethoxy-benzoate (CAS no. 54915-31-0) (10.3 g, 40 mmol) and 3-bromo-l-methyl-pyrrolidin-2-one (Intermediate 4) (8.54 g, 48 mmol) were dissolved in DMF and treated with potassium carbonate (12.1 g, 88 mmol) and stirred at room temperature for 16 hours and then at 50 0 C for 3 hours.
  • the DMF was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue partitioned between ethyl acetate (100 mL) and water (30 mL). The organic layer was separated, washed with brine (30 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ) and evaporated under reduced pressure.
  • the residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0- 100% ethyl acetate in hexane to give the racemic product (8.7 g).
  • the desired product was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using Merck 50mm 20 ⁇ m Chiralpak AS - No ASVOOSC JGOOl and ASVOOOSC BD004 columns in series, eluting with 30% ethylacetate in isohexane at a flow rate of 60 mL / min, using 9 separate injections of 70 mL of a 14 mg/ml solution of the racemate in Ethanol (32 mL) and isohexane (38 mL) to afford the product (3.6 g, 41%) which eluted after its enantiomer.
  • the combined aqueous extracts were acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid, extracted with a mixture of ethyl acetate and DCM (1:1, 3x20 mL), washed with brine, dried (MgSO 4 ), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure.
  • the residue from this was dissolved in THF (2 mL) and methanol (1 mL) and treated with 2M (trimethylsilyl)diazomethane (0.240 mL, 0.48 mmol) and stirred for 30 minutes.
  • the solution was treated with acetic acid (1 drop), evaporated under reduced pressure.
  • the reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure then water (500 mL) and ethyl acetate (500 mL) were added. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous phase was re-extracted with ethyl acetate (5x15OmL). The combined organics were washed with citric acid (250 mL), saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (250 mL), brine (250 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ), filtered and evaporated under reduced pressure to give a solid which was recrystallised in ethyl acetate and dried under reduced pressure to give the product (18.2g, 47%).
  • Methanesulfonyl chloride 13 ⁇ L, 0.16 mmol
  • triethylamine 34 ⁇ L, 0.24 mmol
  • ethyl 2-[3-[6-(azetidme-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]-4-hydroxy-butanoate (Intermediate 28) (65 mg, 0.12 mmol) in DCM (5 niL) at 0°C under nitrogen. The reaction was allowed to warm to RT and stirred for 2 hours.
  • the aqueous fraction was acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid and extracted with ethyl acetate (3x100 mL), the combined organic layers were washed with water (2x20 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ) and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in THF (6 mL) and methanol (3 mL) and was treated dropwise with 2M
  • Azetidine hydrochloride (6.14 g, 65.5 mmol) then triethylamine (24 mL, 187 mmol) were added and the mixture stirred at ambient temperature for 20 hours.
  • the mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure and ethyl acetate (400 mL) added to the residue.
  • the resulting mixture was washed with water (100 mL), filtered, washed with IM citric acid solution (50 mL), saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure.
  • the organic phase was separated, washed with water (10 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ) and evaporated.
  • the aqueous phase was acidified to pH 1 with 2N hydrochloric acid extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 30 mL).
  • the combined organic extracts were washed with water (2 x 20 mL), brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ) and evaporated.
  • the residue was dissolved in THF (2 mL) and methanol (1 mL) and treated with 2M TMS- diazomethane (0.14 mL) stirred for 30 minutes.
  • Enzymatic activity of recombinant human pancreatic GLK may be measured by incubating GLK, ATP and glucose.
  • the rate of product formation may be determined by coupling the assay to a G-6-P dehydrogenase, NADP/NADPH system and measuring the linear increase with time of optical density at 340nm (Brocklehurst et al (Diabetes 2004, 53, 535-541 ).
  • Activation of GLK by compounds can be assessed using this assay in the presence or absence of GLKRP as described in Brocklehurst et al (Diabetes 2004, 53, 535-541).
  • GKHl and GKH4 were used to test the compounds of the invention.
  • the GKHl assay is a manual, bench-top rate assay using 60 nmol/1 of recombinant human pancreatic GLK.
  • the GLK activity rate is measured over a 5 minute window using a Multiskan Ascent spectrophotometer.
  • the GKH4 assay is an automated end-point assay using 10 nmol/1 of recombinant human pancreatic GLK.
  • the GLK activity is measured at 10 minutes after the initiation of the assay on a Perkin Elmer Envision spectrophotometer.
  • GKHl and GKH4 do not contain GLKRP.
  • Compounds of the invention generally have an activating activity for glucokinase with an EC 50 of less than about 20 ⁇ M, such as less than about 5 ⁇ M, such as less than about l ⁇ M, such as less than 50OnM, such as less than about 10OnM.
  • Examples 1 to 32 activated glucokinase in the GKHl and/or GHK4 variants of the assay with EC 50 values as shown below. Table A
  • Human GLK and GLKRP cDNA was obtained by PCR from human pancreatic and hepatic mRNA respectively, using established techniques described in Sambrook J, Fritsch EF & Maniatis T, 1989. PCR primers were designed according to the GLK and GLKRP cDNA sequences shown in Tanizawa et al, Proc Natl Acad Sci 1991 Aug 15;88(16):7294-7 1991 and Bonthron, D.T. et al 1994 (later corrected in and Warner, J.P. et al, Mamm Genome. 1995 Aug;6(8):532-61995).
  • GLK and GLKRP cDNA was cloned in E. coli using pBluescript II.
  • Transformations E. Coli transformations were generally carried out by electroporation. 400 mL cultures of strains DH5a or BL21(DE3) were grown in L-broth to an OD 600 of 0.5 and harvested by centrifugation at 2,00Og. The cells were washed twice in ice-cold deionised water, resuspended in ImL 10% glycerol and stored in aliquots at -70 0 C. Ligation mixes were desalted using Millipore V seriesTM membranes (0.0025mm) pore size). 4OmL of cells were incubated with ImL of ligation mix or plasmid DNA on ice for 10 minutes in 0.2cm electroporation cuvettes, and then pulsed using a Gene PulserTM apparatus (BioRad) at
  • Transformants were selected on L-agar supplemented with tetracyline at lOmg/mL or ampicillin at lOOmg/mL.
  • Expression GLK was expressed from the vector pTB375NBSE in E.coli BL21 cells,, producing a recombinant protein containing a 6-His tag immediately adjacent to the N-terminal methionine.
  • another suitable vector is pET21(+)DNA, Novagen, Cat number 697703.
  • the 6-His tag was used to allow purification of the recombinant protein on a column packed with nickel-nitrilotriacetic acid agarose purchased from Qiagen (cat no 30250).
  • GLKRP was expressed from the vector pFLAG CTC (IBI Kodak) in E.coli BL21 cells, producing a recombinant protein containing a C-terminal FLAG tag.
  • the protein was purified initially by DEAE Sepharose ion exchange followed by utilisation of the FLAG tag for final purification on an M2 anti-FLAG immunoaff ⁇ nity column purchased from Sigma- Aldrich (cat no. A1205).
  • Oral glucose tolerance tests may be performed on conscious Zucker obese fa/fa rats (age 12-13 weeks or older) fed a high fat diet (45 % kcal fat) for at least two weeks prior to experimentation. The animals are fasted for 2 hours before use for experiments. A test compound or a vehicle is given orally 120 minutes before oral administration of a glucose solution at a dose of 2 g/kg body weight. Blood glucose levels are measured using a Accucheck glucometer from tail bled samples taken at different time points before and after administration of glucose (time course of 60 minutes).
  • a time curve of the blood glucose levels is generated and the area-under-the- curve (AUC) for 120 minutes calculated (the time of glucose administration being time zero). Percent reduction in glucose excursion is determined using the AUC in the vehicle-control group as zero percent reduction.
  • Glucokinase activator efficacy in free feeding obese male Zucker fatty rats was assessed by measuring free feeding blood glucose levels in obese male Zucker fatty rats as follows. Rats were received from the AstraZeneca breeding unit at 9 weeks of age and allowed to acclimatise to a reverse light cycle (0900-2100 dark phase) for 3 weeks.
  • vehicle group contains 10 animals and a single test group contains 8 animals; for each additional test group the control group size was increased by 2 animals.
  • Animals were orally dosed, at a volume of 5ml/kg, at 0800 (ie Ih prior to entering the dark phase) with vehicle (1% w/v Pluronic F127) or the test compound (formulated in 1% Pluronic F127) at 3 mg/kg.
  • Blood glucose was measured from a lO ⁇ l needle prick sample from the tail vein and determined using a Roche Accu-chek monitor. Measurements were taken at time zero (ie immediately prior to dosing), 0.5h, Ih, 2h, 3h, 4h, 6h, 8h, 12b. and 24h thereafter. Samples at the 12h and 24h time points were only taken if sufficient efficacy had been observed at the 8 hour time point.

Landscapes

  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Diabetes (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Obesity (AREA)
  • Endocrinology (AREA)
  • Child & Adolescent Psychology (AREA)
  • Emergency Medicine (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Plural Heterocyclic Compounds (AREA)
  • Nitrogen Condensed Heterocyclic Rings (AREA)
  • Agricultural Chemicals And Associated Chemicals (AREA)
  • Catching Or Destruction (AREA)

Abstract

The invention relates to a novel group of compounds of Formula (I) or a salt thereof: wherein R<SUP>1</SUP>, A and HET-1 are as described in the specification, which may be useful in the treatment or prevention of a disease or medical condition mediated through glucokinase (GLK) such as type 2 diabetes. The invention also relates to pharmaceutical compositions comprising said compounds, methods of treatment of diseases mediated by GLK using said compounds and methods for preparing compounds of Formula (I).

Description

CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS
The present invention relates to a group of benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds which may be useful in the treatment or prevention of a disease or medical condition mediated through glucokinase (GLK or GK), leading to a decreased glucose threshold for insulin secretion. In addition the compounds are predicted to lower blood glucose by increasing hepatic glucose uptake. Such compounds may have utility in the treatment of Type 2 diabetes and obesity. The invention also relates to pharmaceutical compositions comprising said compounds and to methods of treatment of diseases mediated by GLK using said compounds. In the pancreatic β-cell and liver parenchymal cells the main plasma membrane glucose transporter is GLUT2. Under physiological glucose concentrations the rate at which GLUT2 transports glucose across the membrane is not rate limiting to the overall rate of glucose uptake in these cells. The rate of glucose uptake is limited by the rate of phosphorylation of glucose to glucose-6-phosphate (G-6-P) which is catalysed by glucokinase (GLK) [I]. GLK has a high (6-1OmM) Km for glucose and is not inhibited by physiological concentrations of G-6-P [I]. GLK expression is limited to a few tissues and cell types, most notably pancreatic β-cells and liver cells (hepatocytes) [I]. In these cells GLK activity is rate limiting for glucose utilisation and therefore regulates the extent of glucose induced insulin secretion and hepatic glycogen synthesis. These processes are critical in the maintenance of whole body glucose homeostasis and both are dysfunctional in diabetes [2].
In one sub-type of diabetes, Maturity-Onset Diabetes of the Young Type 2 (MODY- 2), the diabetes is caused by GLK loss of function mutations [3, 4]. Hyperglycaemia in MODY-2 patients results from defective glucose utilisation in both the pancreas and liver [5]. Defective glucose utilisation in the pancreas of MODY-2 patients results in a raised threshold for glucose stimulated insulin secretion. Conversely, rare activating mutations of GLK reduce this threshold resulting in familial hyperinsulinism [6, 6a, 7]. In addition to the reduced GLK activity observed in MODY-2 diabetics, hepatic glucokinase activity is also decreased in type 2 diabetics [8]. Importantly, global or liver selective overexpression of GLK prevents or reverses the development of the diabetic phenotype in both dietary and genetic models of the disease [9-12]. Moreover, acute treatment of type 2 diabetics with fructose improves glucose tolerance through stimulation of hepatic glucose utilisation [13]. This effect is believed to be mediated through a fructose induced increase in cytosolic GLK activity in the hepatocyte by the mechanism described below [13].
Hepatic GLK activity is inhibited through association with GLK regulatory protein (GLKRP). The GLK/GLKRP complex is stabilised by fructose-6-phosphate (F6P) binding to the GLKRP and destabilised by displacement of this sugar phosphate by fructose- 1 -phosphate (FlP). FlP is generated by fructokinase mediated phosphorylation of dietary fructose. Consequently, GLK/GLKRP complex integrity and hepatic GLK activity is regulated in a nutritionally dependent manner as F6P is dominant in the post-absorptive state whereas FlP predominates in the post-prandial state. In contrast to the hepatocyte, the pancreatic β-cell expresses GLK in the absence of GLKRP. Therefore, β-cell GLK activity is regulated extensively by the availability of its substrate, glucose. Small molecules may activate GLK either directly or through destabilising the GLK/GLKRP complex. The former class of compounds are predicted to stimulate glucose utilisation in both the liver and the pancreas whereas the latter are predicted to act selectively in the liver. However, compounds with either profile are predicted to be of therapeutic benefit in treating Type 2 diabetes as this disease is characterised by defective glucose utilisation in both tissues.
GLK, GLKRP and the KATP channel are expressed in neurones of the hypothalamus, a region of the brain that is important in the regulation of energy balance and the control of food intake [14-18]. These neurones have been shown to express orectic and anorectic neuropeptides [15, 19, 20] and have been assumed to be the glucose-sensing neurones within the hypothalamus that are either inhibited or excited by changes in ambient glucose concentrations [17, 19, 21, 22]. The ability of these neurones to sense changes in glucose levels is defective in a variety of genetic and experimentally induced models of obesity [23- 28]. Intracerebroventricular (icv) infusion of glucose analogues, that are competitive inhibitors of glucokinase, stimulate food intake in lean rats [29, 30]. In contrast, icv infusion of glucose suppresses feeding [31]. Thus, small molecule activators of GLK may decrease food intake and weight gain through central effects on GLK. Therefore, GLK activators may be of therapeutic use in treating eating disorders, including obesity, in addition to diabetes. The hypothalamic effects will be additive or synergistic to the effects of the same compounds acting in the liver and/or pancreas in normalising glucose homeostasis, for the treatment of Type 2 diabetes. Thus the GLK/GLKRP system can be described as a potential "Diabesity" target (of benefit in both Diabetes and Obesity). GLK is also expressed in specific entero-endocrine cells where it is believed to control the glucose sensitive secretion of the incretin peptides GIP (glucose-dependent insulinotropic polypeptide) and GLP-I (Glucagon-Like Peptide- 1) from gut K-cells and L-cells respectively (32, 33, 34). Therefore, small molecule activators of GLK may have additional beneficial effects on insulin secretion, b-cell function and survival and body weight as a consequence of stimulating GIP and GLP-I secretion from these entero-endocrine cells.
In WO00/58293 and WO01/44216 (Roche), a series of benzylcarbamoyl compounds are described as glucokinase activators. The mechanism by which such compounds activate GLK is assessed by measuring the direct effect of such compounds in an assay in which GLK activity is linked to NADH production, which in turn is measured optically - see details of the in vitro assay described hereinafter. Compounds of the present invention may activate GLK directly or may activate GLK by inhibiting the interaction of GLKRP with GLK.
Further GLK activators have been described in WO03/095438 (substituted phenylacetamides, Roche), WO03/055482 (carboxamide and sulphonamide derivatives, Novo Nordisk), WO2004/002481 (arylcarbonyl derivatives, Novo Nordisk), and in WO03/080585 (amino-substituted benzoylaminoheterocycles, Banyu).
Our International application Number: WO03/000267 describes a group of benzoyl amino pyridyl carboxylic acids which are activators of the enzyme glucokinase (GLK).
Our International application Number: WO03/015774 describes compounds of the Formula (A):
Figure imgf000004_0001
(A) wherein R3 is a phenyl or a substituted heterocycle other than a carboxylic acid substituted pyridyl. International application WO2004/076420 (Banyu) describes compounds which are generally a subset of those described in WO03/015774, wherein for example R1 is an (substituted) alkyl ether and R2 is (substituted) phenoxy.
We have surprisingly found a small group of compounds, generally a selected subgroup of those described in WO 03/015774, which have generally superior potency for the GLK enzyme, and more advantageous physical properties, including, for example, higher aqueous solubility, higher permeability, and/or lower plasma protein binding. Consequently, such compounds having a balance of these properties would be expected to display higher plasma free drug levels and superior in vivo efficacy after oral dosing as determined, for example, by activity in Oral Glucose Tolerance Tests (OGTTs) and/or glucose profile. Therefore this group of compounds would be expected to provide superior oral exposure at a lower dose and thereby be particularly suitable for use in the treatment or prevention of a disease or medical condition mediated through GLK. Furthermore, the compounds of the invention may have favourable metabolic profiles and/or toxicity profiles. The compounds of the invention may also have superior potency and/or advantageous physical properties (as described above) and/or favourable toxicity profiles and/or favourable metabolic profiles in comparison with other GLK activators known in the art, as well as those described in WO 03/015774.
Thus, according to the first aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of Formula (I):
Figure imgf000005_0001
(I) wherein:
R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R6;
Ring A is selected from phenyl, HET-2 and HET-3; wherein when Ring A is phenyl it is
0 1X substituted by R and optionally further substituted by a group selected from R ; R2 is selected from -C(O)NR4R5, SOpR4, and -SO2NR4R5; R3 is selected from halo, methyl and trifluoromethyl;
R4 is selected from hydrogen, (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from HET-5, -OR5, -SO2R5, (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R15) and -C(O)NR5R5], (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R15) and HET-5;
HET-5 is a 4-, 5- or 6-membered, C- or N-linked heterocyclyl ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- , and wherein a sulphur atom in the heterocyclic ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O)2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon or nitrogen atom by 1 or 2 (l-4C)alkyl substituents; R5 is hydrogen or (l-4C)alkyl; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- and wherein a sulphur atom in the ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O)2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R8 and/or on an available nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R9; or
R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 6-10 membered bicyclic saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 further nitrogen atom (in addition to the linking N atom), wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)-; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon by 1 substituent selected from hydroxy, methyl and halo, or on an available nitrogen atom by methyl;
R6 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l- 4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di( 1 -4C)alkylamino(l -4C)alkyl; R7 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l- 4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl; R8 is selected from hydroxy, (l-4C)alkoxy, (l-4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1-
4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, di(l-4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, (l-4C)alkylamino, di(l-4C)alkylamino,
(l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and-S(O)p(l-4C)alkyl;
R9 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1- 4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, di(l-4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-
4C)alkyl and-S(0)p(l-4C)alkyl;
HET-2 is a 5- or 6- membered heteroaryl ring, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N; which ring is substituted on an available carbon atom by a substituent selected from R2, and is optionally further substituted on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R3 and/or on an available nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quatemised) by a substituent selected from R10;
R10 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
4C)alkyl, -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl, benzyl, and (l-4C)alkylsulfonyl;
HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system of formula -B-C; wherein B is a Ring is directly attached to the linking oxygen atom and Ring B is phenyl or is a 5- or 6-membered heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or 3 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S (provided there are no 0-0, S-S or 0-S bonds in the ring); wherein Ring B is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from
R11 and/or on any available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R12;
R11 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl, di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and HET-4;
R12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l- 4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl, di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and HET-4;
HET-4 is a 5- or 6-membered, C-or N- linked unsubstituted heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or
3 ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S;
Ring C is a 5-7 membered heterocyclic ring fused to Ring B, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N (provided that there are no 0-0, S-O or
S-S bonds within the ring), wherein any ring carbon or sulfur atom may optionally be oxidised and wherein Ring C is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R13 and/or on any available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R14;
R13 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, benzyl, (l-4C)alkylcarbonyl, (1- 4C)alkylsulphonyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl; R14is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy, hydroxy, fluoro and chloro; R15 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and hydroxy; n is 0 or 1 ; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2; or a salt thereof. In another aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of Formula (II):
Figure imgf000008_0001
(H) wherein:
R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl; HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R6;
Ring A is phenyl, substituted by R2 and optionally further substituted by a group selected from R3;
R2 is selected from -C(O)NR4R5, SOpR4, and -SO2NR4R5;
R3 is selected from halo, methyl and trifluoromethyl; R4 is selected from hydrogen, (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from HET-5, -OR5, -SO2R5, (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R15) and -C(O)NR5R5], (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R15) and HET-5;
HET-5 is a 4-, 5- or 6-membered, C- or N-linked heterocyclyl ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- , and wherein a sulphur atom in the heterocyclic ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O)2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon or nitrogen atom by 1 or 2 (l-4C)alkyl substituents; R5 is hydrogen or (l-4C)alkyl; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- and wherein a sulphur atom in the ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O)2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R8 and/or on an available nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R9; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 6-10 membered bicyclic saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 further nitrogen atom (in addition to the linking N atom), wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)-; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon by 1 substituent selected from hydroxy, methyl and halo, or on an available nitrogen atom by methyl;
R6 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l- 4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl;
R7 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l- 4C)alkylamino( 1 -4C)alkyl; R8 is selected from hydroxy, (l-4C)alkoxy, (l-4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1- 4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, di(l-4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, (l-4C)alkylamino, di(l-4C)alkylamino, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and-S(0)p(l-4C)alkyl; R9 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1-
4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, di(l-4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-
4C)alkyl and -S(0)p(l-4C)alkyl;
R15 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and hydroxy; n is 0 or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2; or a salt thereof.
In another aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of Formula (III):
Figure imgf000010_0001
(III) wherein:
R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R6;
Ring A is HET-2;
HET-2 is a 5- or 6- membered heteroaryl ring, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N; which ring is substituted on an available carbon atom by a substituent selected from R2, and is optionally further substituted on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R3 and/or on an available nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R10;
R2 is selected from -C(O)NR4R5, SOpR4, and -SO2NR4R5;
R3 is selected from halo, methyl and trifluoromethyl; R4 is selected from hydrogen, (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from HET-5, -OR5, -SO2R5, (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R15) and -C(O)NR5R5], (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R15) and HET-5; HET-5 is a 4-, 5- or 6-membered, C- or N-linked heterocyclyl ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- , and wherein a sulphur atom in the heterocyclic ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O)2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon or nitrogen atom by 1 or 2 (l-4C)alkyl substituents; R5 is hydrogen or (l-4C)alkyl; or
R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- and wherein a sulphur atom in the ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O)2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R8 and/or on an available nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R9; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 6-10 membered bicyclic saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 further nitrogen atom (in addition to the linking N atom), wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)-; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon by 1 substituent selected from hydroxy, methyl and halo, or on an available nitrogen atom by methyl; R6 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy (l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl;
R7 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl,
(l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l- 4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl; R is selected from hydroxy, (l-4C)alkoxy, (l-4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1-
4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, di(l-4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, (l-4C)alkylamino, di(l-4C)alkylamino,
(l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and-S(0)p(l-4C)alkyl;
R9 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1-
4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, di(l-4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-
4C)alkyl and -S(0)p(l-4C)alkyl;
R10 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3~6C)cycloalkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
4C)alkyl, -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl, benzyl, and (l-4C)alkylsulfonyl;
R15 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and hydroxy; n is O or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2; or a salt thereof.
In another aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of Formula (IV):
Figure imgf000012_0001
(IV) wherein:
R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R6;
R6 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl; R7 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl,
(l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)allcylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l-
4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl;
Ring A is HET-3; HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system of formula -B-C; wherein B is a ring directly attached to the linking oxygen atom and Ring B is phenyl or is a
5- or 6-membered heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or 3 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S (provided there are no 0-0, S-S or O-S bonds in the ring); wherein Ring B is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R11 and/or on any available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from
R12;
R11 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl, di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and HET-4; R12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl, di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and HET-4;
HET-4 is a 5- or 6-membered, C-or N- linked unsubstituted heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or
3 ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; Ring C is a 5-7 membered heterocyclic ring fused to Ring B, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N (provided that there are no 0-0, S-O or
S-S bonds within the ring), wherein any ring carbon or sulfur atom may optionally be oxidised and wherein Ring C is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R13 and/or on any available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R14;
R13 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, benzyl, (l-4C)alkylcarbonyl, (1-
4C)alkylsulphonyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl;
R14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy, hydroxy, fluoro and chloro; n is O or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2; or a salt thereof. Reference hereinafter to a compound of formula (I) should be understood to apply equally to compounds of formula (II), (III) or (IV), even where not explicitly stated.
It will be appreciated that, where the definition of heterocyclyl group HET-I encompass heteroaryl rings which may be substituted on nitrogen, such substitution may not result in charged quaternary nitrogen atoms, removal of aromaticity of the ring or unstable structures. It will be appreciated that the definition of HET-I is not intended to include any O- O, O-S or S-S bonds. It will be appreciated that the definition of HET-I is not intended to include unstable structures.
It will be understood that any single carbon atom in HET-I may only be substituted by one group R6 in order to maintain aromaticity of the ring. Up to two different carbon atoms in a HET-I ring may be substituted by an R6 group, each of which may be the same or different, provided the structure thereby formed is stable and aromatic.
It will be understood that R8 can be present on any or all available carbon atoms in the heterocyclic ring formed by NR4R5; each carbon atom can be substituted with 1 or 2 R8 groups which may be the same or different, provided the structure thereby formed is stable (so, for example, it is not intended to cover gem-dihydroxy substitution).
It will be understood that where a compound of the formula (I) contains more than one group R5, they may be the same or different.
It will be understood that where a compound of the formula (I) contains more than one group R3, they may be the same or different.
A similar convention applies for all other groups and substituents on a compound of formula (I) as hereinbefore defined.
Compounds of Formula (I) may form salts which are within the ambit of the invention. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are preferred although other salts may be useful in, for example, isolating or purifying compounds.
In another aspect, the invention relates to compounds of formula (I) as hereinabove defined or to a pharmaceutically acceptable salt.
In another aspect, the invention relates to compounds of formula (I) as hereinabove defined or to a pro-drug thereof. Suitable examples of pro-drugs of compounds of formula (I) are in- vivo hydroly sable esters of compounds of formula (I). Therefore in another aspect, the invention relates to compounds of formula (I) as hereinabove defined or to an in- vivo hydrolysable ester thereof. In this specification the generic term "alkyl" includes both straight-chain and branched-chain alkyl groups. However references to individual alkyl groups such as "propyl" are specific for the straight chain version only and references to individual branched-chain alkyl groups such as ^-butyl are specific for the branched chain version only. For example, "(l-4C)alkyl" includes methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl and ^-butyl. An analogous convention applies to other generic terms.
For the avoidance of doubt, reference to the group HET-I containing a nitrogen in the 2-position, is intended to refer to the 2-position relative to the amide nitrogen atom to which the group is attached. For example, HET-I encompasses but is not limited to the heterocycles shown in the following structures:
Figure imgf000015_0001
Suitable examples of HET-I as a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring as hereinbefore defined, include thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrimidinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl and triazolyl.
Suitable examples of HET-2 include thienyl, furyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrimidinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl and triazolyl. Further suitable examples of HET-2 include aromatic heterocycles where a ring nitrogen or sulfur atom has been oxidised but aromaticity has been preserved, for example a pyridine N-oxide. Further suitable examples of HET-2 include thiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl and pyrimidinyl.
Suitable examples for a 4-7 membered ring formed by R4 and R5 together with the ' nitrogen to which they are attached, as hereinbefore defined, include morpholino, thiomorpholino (and versions thereof wherein the sulfur is oxidised to an SO or S(O)2 group), piperidinyl, piperazinyl, pyrrolidinyl, azetidinyl, homopiperazinyl, homo-morpholino, homo- thiomorpholino (and versions thereof wherein the sulfur is oxidised to an SO or S(O)2 group) and homo-piperidinyl. Suitable examples for a 6-10 membered bicyclic heterocyclic ring formed by R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen to which they are attached, as hereinbefore defined, are bicyclic saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring such as those illustrated by the structures shown below (wherein the dotted line indicates the point of attachment to the rest of the molecule and wherein R represents the optional substituents on carbon or nitrogen defined hereinbefore):
Figure imgf000016_0001
Figure imgf000016_0003
[2,2,2] [4,1 ,0] [4,2,0]
Figure imgf000016_0004
Figure imgf000016_0006
[3,2,0] ]
Figure imgf000016_0007
Figure imgf000016_0005
Figure imgf000016_0008
[2,1 ,1] [3,1 ,0] [1 ,1 ,1]
In particular such a ring system is a [2,2,1] system such as
Figure imgf000017_0001
(7-azabicyclo[2.2.1]hept-7-yl). In another embodiment, such a ring system is a [2.1.1] system such as
Figure imgf000017_0002
(2-azabicyclo[2.1.1]hex-2-yl).
Suitable values for the bicyclic system HET-3 formed by ring B fused to Ring C include those where Ring C is pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyrimidinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, homopiperazinyl, morpholinyl, homomorpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, homothiomorpholinyl, oxathianyl, homooxathianyl, furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, imidazolyl, imidazolidinyl, pyrazolyl, isoxazolyl, isothiazolyl, pyranyl, 1 ,A- dioxolanyl, dihydrothienyl, dihydrofuryl and oxathiazepinyl. Further suitable values include those wherein Ring C is oxathiazepinyl, dihydrothienyl, dihydrofuryl, and piperidinyl.
Further suitable values include such ring systems where one or more carbon atoms in Ring C have been oxidised to a carbonyl group, and/or where one or more sulfur atoms in Ring C have been oxidised to an S(O) or S(O)2 group.
Suitable values for Ring B as a 5- or 6-membered heterocyclyl ring are furyl, thienyl, pyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, isoxazolyl, isothiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyrimidinyl and pyridazinyl. Further suitable vaues for Ring B are thiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyrimidinyl and pyridazinyl. Still further suitable values for Ring B are thiazolyl and pyridyl. In another aspect Ring B is phenyl.
For example, HET-3 may suitably be selected from the structures below (which may optionally be substituted as hereinbefore defined):
Figure imgf000018_0001
Figure imgf000018_0002
In a further aspect, suitable values for HET-3 are ring systems where Ring C is a 7- membered ring, for example:
Figure imgf000019_0001
Further suitable values for HET-3 include the following formulae A to F, wherein each R12a is independently hydrogen or is R12 as hereinbefore defined, each R13a is independently hydrogen or is R13 as hereinbefore defined, each R14a is independently hydrogen or is R14 as hereinbefore defined:
Figure imgf000019_0002
Further suitable values for HET-3 include formulae G to P as follows:
Figure imgf000020_0001
It will be appreciated that the bicyclic ring systems shown above are to illustrate the definitions of Ring C and may be applied to any of the possible values for Ring B, even if not shown above.
It will be understood that references herein to Ring C as 1,3-dioxolyl are intended to refer to structures such as the following (illustrated with Ring B is phenyl):
Figure imgf000020_0002
It will be understood that references herein to Ring C as 1,4-dioxolanyl are intended to refer to structures such as the following (illustrated with Ring B is phenyl):
Figure imgf000020_0003
For example suitable values for the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl include the following (wherein each R13a is hydrogen or is selected from R13 as hereinbefore defined, R14a is hydrogen or is selected from R14 as hereinbefore defined and each R12a is hydrogen or is R12 as hereinbefore defined):
Figure imgf000021_0001
In another aspect, the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is selected from formulae AA to MM (wherein R12a is hydrogen or is selected from R12 as hereinbefore defined, R13a is hydrogen or is selected from R13 as hereinbefore defined and each R14a is hydrogen or R14 as hereinbefore defined):
Figure imgf000021_0003
Figure imgf000021_0002
CC DD
Figure imgf000022_0001
LL MM
In one aspect, the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is selected from:
Figure imgf000022_0002
particularly wherein R13ais hydrogen or is methyl and R12a is hydrogen or is R12 as hereinbefore defined, for example R12a is hydrogen or fluoro, or for example R12a is hydrogen.
In another aspect, the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is selected from
Figure imgf000022_0003
particularly, wherein both R14a are hydrogen, R13ais hydrogen or is methyl and Rl2a is hydrogen or is R12 as hereinbefore defined, for example R12a is hydrogen or fluoro, or for example R12a is hydrogen. In one embodiment of this aspect, the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is of formula EE. In another embodiment of this aspect, the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is of formula FF. In another embodiment of this aspect, the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is of formula GG. In another embodiment of this aspect, the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is of formula HH.
In another aspect, the bicyclic system formed by Ring C fused to Ring B as phenyl is of formula (Z):
Figure imgf000023_0001
Z wherein Rz is hydrogen or fluoro, Z1 is CH2 or NR13a, R13ais hydrogen or methyl, and Z2 is C(O) or SO2. In a further aspect, Ring C is an optionally substituted 5-7 membered heterocyclic ring fused to the benzene ring, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N (provided that there are no 0-0, S-O or S-S bonds within the ring), wherein any ring carbon or sulfur atom may optionally be oxidised, provided that where Ring C contains two ring heteroatoms they are not both oxygen (such that for example, Ring C is not dioxolyl or dioxolanyl).
Suitable examples of HET-4 include thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrimidinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl and triazolyl.
It will be understood that HET-5 can be a saturated, or partially or fully unsaturated ring.
Suitable examples of HET-5 include azetidinyl, furyl, thienyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrimidinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, morpholino, morpholinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, pyrrolyl, pyrrolidinyl, pyrrolidonyl, 2,5-dioxopyrrolidinyl, 1,1- dioxotetrahydrothienyl, 2-oxoimidazolidinyl, 2,4-dioxoimidazolidinyl, 2-oxo-l,3,4-(4- triazolinyl), 2-oxazolidinonyl, 2-oxotetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholino, 1,3 -dioxolanyl, 1,2,4-triazolyl, 1,2,3-triazolyl, pyranyl, and 4-pyridonyl. It will be understood that HET-5 may be linked by any appropriate available C or N atom, therefore for example, for HET-5 as "imidazolyl" includes 1- , 2-, 4- and 5- imidazolyl. Examples of (l-4C)alkyl include methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl and tert-butyl; examples of (3-6C)cycloalkyl include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl and cyclohexyl; examples of halo include fluoro, chloro, bromo and iodo; examples of hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl include hydroxymethyl, 1-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxypropyl, 3-hydroxypropyl, 1-hydroxyisopropyl and 4-hydroxybutyl; examples of (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl include methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, tert-butoxymethyl, 2-methoxyethyl, 2-ethoxyethyl, methoxypropyl, 2-methoxypropyl and methoxybutyl; example of (l-4C)alkoxy include methoxy, ehtoxy, propoxy, isopropxy, butoxy and tert-butoxy; examples of (1- 4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl (where p is 0, 1 or 2) include methylsulfmylmethyl, ethylsulfinylmethyl, ethylsulfinylethyl, methylsulfinylpropyl, methylsulfinylbutyl, methylsulfonylmethyl, ethylsulfonylmethyl, ethylsulfonylethyl, methylsulfonylpropyl, methylsulfonylbutyl, methylthiomethyl, ethylthiomethyl, ethylthioethyl, methylthiopropyl, and methylthiobutyl; examples of (l-4C)alkylsulfonyl include methylsulfonyl, ethylsulfonyl, propylsulfonyl, isopropylsulfonyl and tert-butylsulfonyl; examples of-S(0)p(l-4C)alkyl include (l-4C)alkylsulfonyl, methylsulfinyl, ethylsulfinyl, propylsulfinyl, isopropylsulfinyl, tert-butylsulfmyl, methylthio, ethylthio, propylthio, isopropylthio and tert-butylthio; examples of amino(l-4C)alkyl include aminomethyl, aminoethyl, 2-aminopropyl, 3-aminopropyl, 1- aminoisopropyl and 4-aminobutyl; examples of (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl include (N- methyl)aminomethyl, (N-ethyl)aminomethyl, l-((N-methyl)amino)ethyl, 2-((N- methyl)amino)ethyl, (N-ethyl)aminoethyl, (N-methyl)aminopropyl, and 4-((N- methyl)amino)butyl; examples of di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl include dimethylaminomethyl, methyl(ethyl)aminomethyl, methyl(ethyl)aminoethyl, (N,N- diethyl)aminoethyl, (N,N-dimethyl)aminopropyl and (N,N-dimethyl)aminobutyl; examples of -C(O)(l-4C)alkyl and (l-4C)alkylcarbonyl include methylcarbonyl, ethylcarbonyl, propylcarbonyl and tert-butyl carbonyl; examples of (l-4C)alky!amino include methylamino, ethylamino, propylamino, isopropylamino, butylamino and tert-butylamino; examples of di(l-4C)alkylamino include dimethylamino, diethylamino, N-methyl-N-ethylamino, dipropylamino, N-isopropyl-N-methyamino and dibutylamino; examples of (1- 4C)alkylarainocarbonyl include methylaminocarbonyl, ethylaminocarbonyl, propylaminocarbonyl, isopropylaminocarbonyl, butylaminocarbonyl and tert- butylaminocarbonyl; examples of di(l-4C)alkylaminocarbonyl include dimethylaminocarbonyl, diethylaniinocarbonyl, N-methyl-N-ethylaminocarbonyl, dipropylaminocarbonyl, N-isopropyl-N-methyaminocarbonyl and dibutylaminocarbonyl.
It is to be understood that, insofar as certain of the compounds of Formula (I) defined above may exist in optically active or racemic forms by virtue of one or more asymmetric carbon atoms, the invention includes in its definition any such optically active or racemic form which possesses the property of stimulating GLK directly or inhibiting the GLK/GLKRP interaction. The synthesis of optically active forms may be carried out by standard techniques of organic chemistry well known in the art, for example by synthesis from optically active starting materials or by resolution of a racemic form. It is also to be understood that certain compounds may exist in tautomeric forms and that the invention also relates to any and all tautomeric forms of the compounds of the invention which activate GLK.
In one aspect, the compound of formula (I) has the (S)-configuration at the pyrrolidone ring and is thereby a compound of formula (IA):
Figure imgf000025_0001
(IA)
In another aspect, the compound of formula (I) has the (Reconfiguration at the pyrrolidone ring and is thereby a compound of formula (IB):
Figure imgf000025_0002
(IB)
The above convention applies equally to compounds of formulae (II), (III) and (IV), so that, for example, when a compound of formula (II) has the pyrrolidine in the S- confϊguration, it may be described as a compound of formula (IIA), and when a compound of formula (II) has the pyrrolidone substituent in the (R)-configuration it may be described as a compound of formula (HB).
Thus reference herein to a compound of formula (I) should be understood to refer equally to a compound of formula (I), (IA), (IB), (II), (IIA), (IIB), (III), (IIIA), (IIIB), (IV), (IVA) and (IVB).
It is also to be understood that certain compounds of the formula (I) and salts thereof can exist in solvated as well as unsolvated forms such as, for example, hydrated forms. It is to be understood that the invention encompasses all such solvated forms which activate GLK. In one embodiment of the invention are provided compounds of formula (I), in an alternative embodiment are provided pharmaceutically-acceptable salts of compounds of formula (I), in a further alternative embodiment are provided in- vivo hydrolysable esters of compounds of formula (I), and in a further alternative embodiment are provided pharmaceutically-acceptable salts of in-vivo hydrolysable esters of compounds of formula (I). Preferred values of each variable group are as follows. Such values may be used where appropriate with any of the values, definitions, claims, aspects or embodiments defined hereinbefore or hereinafter. In particular, each may be used as an individual limitation on the broadest definition of formulae (I), (II), (III) and/or (IV), as appropriate. Further, each of the following values may be used in combination with one or more of the other following values to limit the broadest defmtion of formulae (I), (II), (III) and/or (IV), as appropriate.
(1) R1 is (l-4C)alkyl
(2) R1 is methyl or ethyl
(3) R1 is (3-6C)acycloalkyl, such as cyclobutyl (4) R1 is methyl, ethyl or cyclobutyl
(5) HET-I is a 5-membered heteroaryl ring
(6) HET-I is a 6-membered heteroaryl ring
(7) HET-I is substituted with 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R6
(8) HET-I is substituted with 1 substituent selected from R6 (9) HET-I is substituted with 1 substituent selected from R7
(10) HET-I is unsubstituted (11) HET-I is selected from thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyridyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrimidinyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, and triazolyl
(12) HET-I is selected from thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl and oxadiazolyl
(13) HET-I is pyrazolyl, optionally substituted with a methyl group on an available carbon
(14) HET-I is pyrazinyl, optionally substituted with a methyl group on an available carbon atom
(15) HET-I is thiazolyl, optionally substituted with a methyl group on an available carbon atom
(16) HET-I is pyrazinyl, pyrazolyl or thiazolyl, optionally substituted with a methyl group on an available carbon atom
(17) R6 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and di(l-4C)alkylamino(l- 4C)alkyl (18) R6 is selected from methyl, ethyl, bromo, chloro, fluoro, hydroxymethyl, methoxymethyl, aminomethyl, N-methylaminomethyl, dimethylaminomethyl
(19) R6 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, (1-
4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl, and di(l-
4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl (20) R6 is selected from methyl, ethyl, bromo, chloro, fluoro, hydroxymethyl and methoxymethyl
(21) R6 is selected from methyl, ethyl, chloro and fluoro
(22) R6 is methyl
(23) R7 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl (24) R7 is selected from methyl, ethyl, hydroxymethyl, methoxymethyl, aminomethyl, N-methylaminomethyl, dimethylaminomethyl
(25) R7 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, (1- 4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl, and di(l- 4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl (26) R7 is selected from methyl, ethyl, aminomethyl, N-methylaminomethyl, and dimethylaminomethyl (27) R7 is selected from methyl, ethyl, hydroxymethyl and methoxymethyl (28) R7 is selected from methyl and ethyl
(29) R7 is methyl
(30) Ring A is phenyl (31) Ring A is HET-2 (32) Ring A is HET-3
(33) R3 is chloro or fluoro
(34) R3 is chloro
(35) R3 is fluoro
(36) R2 is -C(O)NR4R5 (37) R2 is -SO2NR4R5
(38) R2 is SOpR4
(39) R2 is -C(O)NR4R5 or SOPR4
(40) R4 is selected from hydrogen, optionally substituted (l-4C)alkyl and optionally substituted (3-6C)cycloalkyl (41) R4 is (l-4C)alkyl, such as methyl
(42) R5 is (l-4C)alkyl, such as methyl
(43) R5 is hydrogen
(44) R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 membered ring (45) R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 5 membered ring
(46) R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 6 membered ring
(47) R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 7 membered ring
(48) R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a fully saturated ring
(49) R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a ring selected from morpholino, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, pyrrolidinyl and azetidinyl (50) R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form an azetidinyl ring (5I) R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form an unsubstituted ring
(52) R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a ring mono- substituted either with a substituent R8 or with a substituent R9 (53) R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 6-10 membered bicyclic saturated or partially unsaturated ring
(54) R8 is selected from hydroxy, (l-4C)alkoxy, (l-4C)alkyl
(55) R8 is selected from hydroxy, methoxy and methyl
(56) R9 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl (57) R2 is azetidinylcarbonyl
(58) HET-2 is a 5-membered heteroaryl ring
(59) HET-2 is a 6-membere heteroaryl ring
(60) HET-2 is selected from pyrazinyl and pyridyl
(61) HET-2 is substituted with a substituent selected from R3 (62) HET-2 has one nitrogen substituent selected from R10
(63) R10 is (l-4C)alkyl
(64) R10 is (3-6C)cycloalkyl
(65) R10 is hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl or (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl
(66) R10 is -C(O)(l-4C)alkyl (67) R10 is benzyl
(68) R10 is (l-4C)alkylsulfonyl
(69) R10 is (l-4C)alkyl or benzyl (70) n = 0
(71) n = l (72) Ring B is phenyl
(73) Ring B is 5- or 6-membered heteroaryl ring
(74) Ring B is phenyl or a 6-membered heteroaryl ring
(75) Ring B is a 5-membered heteroaryl ring
(76) Ring B is a 6-membered heteroaryl ring (77) Ring C is a 5-membered ring
(78) Ring C is a 6-membered ring
(79) Ring C is a 7-membered ring (80) Ring C is unsubstituted
(81) Ring C is substituted on an available nitrogen atom by R13
(82) Ring C is substituted on each available nitrogen atom by a substituent R13, wherein each R13 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl and benzyl (83) Ring C is substituted on an available carbon atom by R14
(84) Ring C is substituted on more than one available carbon atom by substituents independently selected from R14
(85) Ring C is substituted on one or more available carbon atom by methyl, and/or twice on one carbon atom by methyl (86) Ring B is heteroaryl and Ring C is phenyl
(87) Ring B is heteroaryl and Ring C is heterocyclyl
(88) HET-3 is a 5,6 fused bicyclic system
(89) HET-3 is a 5,5 fused bicyclic system
(90) HET-3 is a 6,6 fused bicyclic system (91) HET-3 is a 5 ,7 fused bicyclic system
(92) HET-3 is a 6,7 fused bicyclic system
(93) HET-3 is selected from structures A to F as hereinbefore defined, particularly wherein R13 and R14 are both methyl and R12 is chloro or fluoro
(94) HET-3 is selected from structures G to P as hereinbefore defined (95) Ring C is substituted by two R14 and both are either methyl or fluoro
(96) Ring C is gem di-substituted by R14 and both are either methyl or fluoro
(97) R12 is hydrogen
(98) R12 is fluoro
(99) R12 is chloro (100) R12 is hydrogen or fluoro
(101) HET-3 is selected from structures AA to MM as hereinbefore defined
(102) HET-3 is selected from structures EE, FF, GG and HH
(103) HET-3 is selected from structures EE, FF and GG
According to a further feature of the invention there is provided the following preferred groups of compounds of the invention:
In one aspect there is provided a compound of formula (I), or a salt thereof, wherein: R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl; HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R6;
Ring A is selected from phenyl, HET-2 and HET-3; wherein when Ring A is phenyl it is substituted by R2 and optionally further substituted by a group selected from R3;
R2 is selected from -C(O)NR4R5, SOpR4, and -SO2NR4R5; R3 is selected from halo, methyl and trifluoromethyl;
R4 is selected from hydrogen and (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by a substituent selected from -OR5 and -C(O)NR5R5];
R5 is hydrogen or (l-4C)alkyl; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- and wherein a sulphur atom in the ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O)2 group; R6 is (l-4C)alkyl;
R7 is (l-4C)alkyl;
HET-2 is a 5- or 6- membered heteroaryl ring, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N; which ring is substituted on an available carbon atom by a substituent selected from R2, and is optionally further substituted on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R3 and/or on an available nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R10;
R10 is (l-4C)alkyl;
HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system of formula -B-C; wherein B is a Ring is directly attached to the linking oxygen atom and Ring B is phenyl or is a 5- or 6-membered heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or 3 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S (provided there are no 0-0, S-S or 0-S bonds in the ring); wherein Ring B is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R11 and/or on any available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from
R12;
Rn is (l-4C)alkyl; R12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl and halo;
Ring C is a 5-7 membered heterocyclic ring fused to Ring B, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N (provided that there are no 0-0, S-O or
S-S bonds within the ring), wherein any ring carbon or sulfur atom may optionally be oxidised and wherein Ring C is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R13 and/or on any available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R14;
R13 is (l-4C)alkyl;
R14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, fluoro and chloro; n is 0 or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2.
In another aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of formula (II), or a salt thereof, wherein
R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R6; Ring A is phenyl, substituted by R2 and optionally further substituted by a group selected
R2 is selected from -C(O)NR4R5, SOpR4 and -SO2NR4R5;
R3 is halo;
R4 is selected from hydrogen and (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by a substituent selected from -OR5 and -C(O)NR5R5] ;
R5 is hydrogen or (l-4C)alkyl; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- and wherein a sulphur atom in the ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O)2 group;
R6 is (l-4C)alkyl;
R7 is (l-4C)alkyl; n is 0 or 1 ; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2. In a further aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of formula (IV), or a salt thereof, wherein:
R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R6;
Ring A is HET-3; HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system selected from formulae A to P as hereinbefore defined;
R12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl and halo;
R13 is (l-4C)alkyl;
R14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, fluoro and chloro;
R6 is (l-4C)alkyl; R7 is (l-4C)alkyl; n is 0 or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2.
In a further aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of formula (IV), or a salt thereof, wherein: R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R6; Ring A is HET-3;
HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system selected from formulae AA to MM as hereinbefore defined;
R12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl and halo;
R13 is (l-4C)alkyl; R14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, fiuoro and chloro;
R6 is (l-4C)alkyl;
R7 is (l-4C)alkyl; n is 0 or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2. In a further aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of formula (IV), or a salt thereof, wherein:
R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R6;
Ring A is HET-3; HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system selected from formulae EE, FF, GG and HH as hereinbefore defined;
R12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl and halo;
R13 is (l-4C)alkyl;
R14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, fiuoro and chloro; R6 is (l-4C)alkyl;
R7 is (l-4C)alkyl; n is 0 or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2.
According to a further feature of the invention there is provided any one, two or more of the following compounds, or salts thereof: 3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-
(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3 - [6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 - [(3R)-I -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl] oxy-N-
(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[5-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyrazin-2-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N- (4-methyl 1 ,3 -thiazol-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[5-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyrazin-2-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-
(4-methyl 1 ,3-thiazol-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[4-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)phenoxy]-5-[(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(lH- pyrazol-3-yl)benzamide; 3-[5-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)-3-chloro-pyridin-2-yl]oxy-5-[(3 S)-I -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)-5-(4- methylsulfonylphenoxy)benzamide;
3-[4-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)phenoxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(2,2-dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-7,9,ll-trien-9-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2- oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3 - [6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 -( 1 -ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl)oxy-N-(5 - methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide; 3-[(5-methyl-6,6-dioxo-2-oxa-6-λ6-thia-5-azabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8,10,12-trien-10-yl)oxy]-
5-(l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N- pyrazin-2-yl-benzamide;
3-[6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N- pyridin-2-yl-benzamide;
3-[(ll-chloro-5-methyl-6-oxo-2-oxa-5-azabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8,10,12-trien-10-yl)oxy]-5-
[(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide; 3-[(4-methyl-5-oxo-2-oxa-4-azabicyclo[4.4.0]deca-6,8,10-trien-9-yl)oxy]-5-(l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-yl)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(5-methyl-6-oxo-2-oxa-5-azabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8,10,12-trien-10-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l- methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide; 3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-(l-cyclobutyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl)oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[6-(Azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)- 1 -cyclopropyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-cyclopropyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)-l-cyclobutyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-
N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[6-(Azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3 S)- 1 -cyclobutyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-
N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide; 3-[6-(Azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)- 1 -ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[6-(Azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3 S)- l-ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
N,N-Dimethyl-5-[3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]pyrazine-2-carboxamide;
3-[(2,2-Dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-7,9,ll-trien-9-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-
2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(lH-pyrazol-3-yl)benzamide;
3-[2-Chloro-4-(dimethylcarbamoyl)phenoxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-
(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide; 3-[(6,6-dioxo-2-oxa-6-λ6-thia-5-azabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8,10,12-trien-10-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l- methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)-5-(6- methylsulfonylpyridin-3-yl)oxy-benzamide;
N,N-dimethyl-5-[3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]pyridine-2-carboxamide ;
3-[(9-methyl- 10-oxo-7-oxa-9-azabicyclo[4.4.0]deca-2,4, 1 l-trien-4-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)- 1 -methyl-
2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(lH-pyrazol-3-yl)benzamide; N,N-dimethyl-5-[3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3-methyl-l,2,4-tliiadiazol- 5 -yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]pyrazine-2-carboxamide; and
N,N-Dimethyl-5-[3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(4-methyl-l,3-thiazol-2- yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]pyrazine-2-carboxamide. The compounds of the invention may be administered in the form of a pro-drag. A pro-drug is a bioprecursor or pharmaceutically acceptable compound being degradable in the body to produce a compound of the invention (such as an ester or amide of a compound of the invention, particularly an in- vivo hydroly sable ester). Various forms of prodrugs are known in the art. For examples of such prodrug derivatives, see: a) Design of Prodrugs, edited by H. Bundgaard, (Elsevier, 1985) and Methods in Enzymology, Vol. 42, p. 309-396, edited by K. Widder, et al. (Academic Press, 1985); b) A Textbook of Drug Design and Development, edited by Krogsgaard-Larsen; c) H. Bundgaard, Chapter 5 "Design and Application of Prodrugs", by H. Bundgaard p. 113-191 (1991); d) H. Bundgaard, Advanced Drug Delivery Reviews, 8, 1-38 (1992); e) H. Bundgaard, et al., Journal of Pharmaceutical Sciences, 77, 285 (1988); and f) N. Kakeya, et al, Chem Pharm Bull, 32, 692 (1984).
The contents of the above cited documents are incorporated herein by reference.
Examples of pro-drags are as follows. An in- vivo hydrolysable ester of a compound of the invention containing a carboxy or a hydroxy group is, for example, a pharmaceutically- acceptable ester which is hydrolysed in the human or animal body to produce the parent acid or alcohol. Suitable pharmaceutically-acceptable esters for carboxy include
C1 to Cgalkoxymethyl esters for example methoxymethyl, C1 to C ealkanoyloxymethyl esters for example pivaloyloxymethyl, phthalidyl esters, C3 to CgcycloalkoxycarbonyloxyC] to C6alkyl esters for example
1-cyclohexylcarbonyloxyethyl; l,3-dioxolen-2-onylmethyl esters, for example 5-methyl-l,3- dioxolen-2-onylmethyl; and Ci.6alkoxycarbonyloxyethyl esters.
An in- vivo hydrolysable ester of a compound of the invention containing a hydroxy group includes inorganic esters such as phosphate esters (including phosphoramidic cyclic esters) and α-acyloxyalkyl ethers and related compounds which as a result of the in- vivo hydrolysis of the ester breakdown to give the parent hydroxy group/s. Examples of α-acyloxyalkyl ethers include acetoxymethoxy and 2,2-dimethylpropionyloxy-methoxy. A selection of in- vivo hydrolysable ester forming groups for hydroxy include alkanoyl, benzoyl, phenylacetyl and substituted benzoyl and phenylacetyl, alkoxycarbonyl (to give alkyl carbonate esters), dialkylcarbamoyl and N-(dialkylaminoethyl)-N-alkylcarbamoyl (to give carbamates), dialkylaminoacetyl and carboxyacetyl. Under certain conditions, compounds of Formula (I) may form pharmaceutically acceptable salts. A suitable pharmaceutically-acceptable salt of a compound of the invention is, for example, an acid-addition salt of a compound of the invention which is sufficiently basic, for example, an acid-addition salt with, for example, an inorganic or organic acid, for example hydrochloric, hydrobromic, sulphuric, phosphoric, trifluoroacetic, citric or maleic acid. In addition a suitable pharmaceutically acceptable salt of a compound of the invention which is sufficiently acidic is an alkali metal salt, for example a sodium or potassium salt, an alkaline earth metal salt, for example a calcium or magnesium salt, an ammonium salt or a salt with an organic base which affords a physiologically-acceptable cation, for example a salt with methylamine, dimethylamine, trimethylamine, piperidine, morpholine or tris-(2-hydroxyethyl)amine.
A further feature of the invention is a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of Formula (I) as defined above, or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, together with a pharmaceutically-acceptable diluent or carrier.
According to another aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of Formula (I) as defined above or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof for use as a medicament.
According to another aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof as defined above for use as a medicament for treatment of a disease mediated through GLK, in particular type 2 diabetes.
Further according to the invention there is provided the use of a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof in the preparation of a medicament for treatment of a disease mediated through GLK, in particular type 2 diabetes.
The compound is suitably formulated as a pharmaceutical composition for use in this way.
According to another aspect of the present invention there is provided a method of treating GLK mediated diseases, especially diabetes, by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, to a mammal in need of such treatment. According to another aspect of the present invention there is provided the use of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, for treatment of a disease mediated through GLK.
According to another aspect of the present invention there is provided the use of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, for treatment of type 2 diabetes.
Specific diseases which may be treated by a compound or composition of the invention include: blood glucose lowering in Type 2 Diabetes Mellitus without a serious risk of hypoglycaemia (and potential to treat type 1), dyslipidemia, obesity, insulin resistance, metabolic syndrome X, impaired glucose tolerance.
As discussed above, thus the GLK/GLKRP system can be described as a potential "Diabesity" target (of benefit in both Diabetes and Obesity). Thus, according to another aspect of the invention there is provided the use of a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, in the preparation of a medicament for use in the combined treatment or prevention, particularly treatment, of diabetes and obesity.
According to another aspect of the invention there is provided the use of a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, in the preparation of a medicament for use in the treatment or prevention of obesity.
According to a further aspect of the invention there is provided a method for the combined treatment of obesity and diabetes by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, to a mammal in need of such treatment.
According to another aspect of the invention there is provided a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof as defined above for use as a medicament for treatment or prevention, particularly treatment of obesity.
According to a further aspect of the invention there is provided a method for the treatment of obesity by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I) or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, to a mammal in need of such treatment.
Compounds of the invention may be particularly suitable for use as pharmaceuticals because of advantageous physical and/or pharmacokinetic properties, and/or favourable toxicity profile. The compositions of the invention may be in a form suitable for oral use (for example as tablets, lozenges, hard or soft capsules, aqueous or oily suspensions, emulsions, dispersible powders or granules, syrups or elixirs), for topical use (for example as creams, ointments, gels, or aqueous or oily solutions or suspensions), for administration by inhalation (for example as a finely divided powder or a liquid aerosol), for administration by insufflation (for example as a finely divided powder) or for parenteral administration (for example as a sterile aqueous or oily solution for intravenous, subcutaneous, intramuscular or intramuscular dosing or as a suppository for rectal dosing). Dosage forms suitable for oral use are preferred.
The compositions of the invention may be obtained by conventional procedures using conventional pharmaceutical excipients, well known in the art. Thus, compositions intended for oral use may contain, for example, one or more colouring, sweetening, flavouring and/or preservative agents.
Suitable pharmaceutically acceptable excipients for a tablet formulation include, for example, inert diluents such as lactose, sodium carbonate, calcium phosphate or calcium carbonate, granulating and disintegrating agents such as corn starch or algenic acid; binding agents such as starch; lubricating agents such as magnesium stearate, stearic acid or talc; preservative agents such as ethyl or propyl rj-hydroxybenzoate, and anti-oxidants, such as ascorbic acid. Tablet formulations may be uncoated or coated either to modify their disintegration and the subsequent absorption of the active ingredient within the gastrointestinal tract, or to improve their stability and/or appearance, in either case, using conventional coating agents and procedures well known in the art.
Compositions for oral use may be in the form of hard gelatin capsules in which the active ingredient is mixed with an inert solid diluent, for example, calcium carbonate, calcium phosphate or kaolin, or as soft gelatin capsules in which the active ingredient is mixed with water or an oil such as peanut oil, liquid paraffin, or olive oil.
Aqueous suspensions generally contain the active ingredient in finely powdered form together with one or more suspending agents, such as sodium carboxymethylcellulose, methylcellulose, hydroxypropylmethylcellulose, sodium alginate, polyvinyl-pyrrolidone, gum tragacanth and gum acacia; dispersing or wetting agents such as lecithin or condensation products of an alkylene oxide with fatty acids (for example polyoxethylene stearate), or condensation products of ethylene oxide with long chain aliphatic alcohols, for example heptadecaethyleneoxycetanol, or condensation products of ethylene oxide with partial esters derived from fatty acids and a hexitol such as polyoxyethylene sorbitol monooleate, or condensation products of ethylene oxide with long chain aliphatic alcohols, for example heptadecaethyleneoxycetanol, or condensation products of ethylene oxide with partial esters derived from fatty acids and a hexitol such as polyoxyethylene sorbitol monooleate, or condensation products of ethylene oxide with partial esters derived from fatty acids and hexitol anhydrides, for example polyethylene sorbitan monooleate. The aqueous suspensions may also contain one or more preservatives (such as ethyl or propyl p_-hydroxybenzoate, antioxidants (such as ascorbic acid), colouring agents, flavouring agents, and/or sweetening agents (such as sucrose, saccharine or aspartame). Oily suspensions may be formulated by suspending the active ingredient in a vegetable oil (such as arachis oil, olive oil, sesame oil or coconut oil) or in a mineral oil (such as liquid paraffin). The oily suspensions may also contain a thickening agent such as beeswax, hard paraffin or cetyl alcohol. Sweetening agents such as those set out above, and flavouring agents may be added to provide a palatable oral preparation. These compositions may be preserved by the addition of an anti-oxidant such as ascorbic acid.
Dispersible powders and granules suitable for preparation of an aqueous suspension by the addition of water generally contain the active ingredient together with a dispersing or wetting agent, suspending agent and one or more preservatives. Suitable dispersing or wetting agents and suspending agents are exemplified by those already mentioned above. Additional excipients such as sweetening, flavouring and colouring agents, may also be present.
The pharmaceutical compositions of the invention may also be in the form of oil-in- water emulsions. The oily phase may be a vegetable oil, such as olive oil or arachis oil, or a mineral oil, such as for example liquid paraffin or a mixture of any of these. Suitable emulsifying agents may be, for example, naturally-occurring gums such as gum acacia or gum tragacanth, naturally-occurring phosphatides such as soya bean, lecithin, an esters or partial esters derived from fatty acids and hexitol anhydrides (for example sorbitan monooleate) and condensation products of the said partial esters with ethylene oxide such as polyoxyethylene sorbitan monooleate. The emulsions may also contain sweetening, flavouring and preservative agents. Syrups and elixirs may be formulated with sweetening agents such as glycerol, propylene glycol, sorbitol, aspartame or sucrose, and may also contain a demulcent, preservative, flavouring and/or colouring agent.
The pharmaceutical compositions may also be in the form of a sterile injectable aqueous or oily suspension, which may be formulated according to known procedures using one or more of the appropriate dispersing or wetting agents and suspending agents, which have been mentioned above. A sterile injectable preparation may also be a sterile injectable solution or suspension in a non-toxic parenterally-acceptable diluent or solvent, for example a solution in 1,3-butanediol. Compositions for administration by inhalation may be in the form of a conventional pressurised aerosol arranged to dispense the active ingredient either as an aerosol containing finely divided solid or liquid droplets. Conventional aerosol propellants such as volatile fluorinated hydrocarbons or hydrocarbons may be used and the aerosol device is conveniently arranged to dispense a metered quantity of active ingredient. For further information on formulation the reader is referred to Chapter 25.2 in
Volume 5 of Comprehensive Medicinal Chemistry (Corwin Hansch; Chairman of Editorial Board), Pergamon Press 1990.
The amount of active ingredient that is combined with one or more excipients to produce a single dosage form will necessarily vary depending upon the host treated and the particular route of administration. For example, a formulation intended for oral administration to humans will generally contain, for example, from 0.5 mg to 2 g of active agent compounded with an appropriate and convenient amount of excipients which may vary from about 5 to about 98 percent by weight of the total composition. Dosage unit forms will generally contain about 1 mg to about 500 mg of an active ingredient. For further information on Routes of Administration and Dosage Regimes the reader is referred to Chapter 25.3 in Volume 5 of Comprehensive Medicinal Chemistry (Corwin Hansch; Chairman of Editorial Board), Pergamon Press 1990.
The size of the dose for therapeutic or prophylactic purposes of a compound of the Formula (I) will naturally vary according to the nature and severity of the conditions, the age and sex of the animal or patient and the route of administration, according to well known principles of medicine. In using a compound of the Formula (I) for therapeutic or prophylactic purposes it will generally be administered so that a daily dose in the range, for example, 0.5 mg to 75 mg per kg body weight is received, given if required in divided doses. In general lower doses will be administered when a parenteral route is employed. Thus, for example, for intravenous administration, a dose in the range, for example, 0.5 mg to 30 mg per kg body weight will generally be used. Similarly, for administration by inhalation, a dose in the range, for example, 0.5 mg to 25 mg per kg body weight will be used. Oral administration is however preferred.
The elevation of GLK activity described herein may be applied as a sole therapy or in combination with one or more other substances and/or treatments for the indication being treated. Such conjoint treatment may be achieved by way of the simultaneous, sequential or separate administration of the individual components of the treatment. Simultaneous treatment may be in a single tablet or in separate tablets. For example in the treatment of diabetes mellitus, chemotherapy may include the following main categories of treatment: 1) Insulin and insulin analogues;
2) Insulin secretagogues including sulphonylureas (for example glibenclamide, glipizide), prandial glucose regulators (for example repaglinide, nateglinide);
3) Agents that improve incretin action (for example dipeptidyl peptidase IV inhibitors, and GLP-I agonists); 4) Insulin sensitising agents including PPARgamma agonists (for example pioglitazone and rosiglitazone), and agents with combined PPARalpha and gamma activity; 5) Agents that modulate hepatic glucose balance (for example metformin, fructose 1, 6 bisphosphatase inhibitors, glycogen phopsphorylase inhibitors, glycogen synthase kinase inhibitors); 6) Agents designed to reduce the absorption of glucose from the intestine (for example acarbose);
7) Agents that prevent the reabsorption of glucose by the kidney (SGLT inhibitors);
8) Agents designed to treat the complications of prolonged hyperglycaemia (for example aldose reductase inhibitors); 9) Anti-obesity agents (for example sibutramine and orlistat);
10) Anti- dyslipidaemia agents such as, HMG-CoA reductase inhibitors (eg statins); PP ARa agonists (fibrates, eg gemfibrozil); bile acid sequestrants (cholestyramine); cholesterol absorption inhibitors (plant stands, synthetic inhibitors); bile acid absorption inhibitors (IBATi) and nicotinic acid and analogues (niacin and slow release formulations);
11) Antihypertensive agents such as, β blockers (eg atenolol, inderal); ACE inhibitors (eg lisinopril); Calcium antagonists (eg. nifedipine); Angiotensin receptor antagonists (eg candesartan), α antagonists and diuretic agents (eg. furosemide, benzthiazide);
12) Haemostasis modulators such as, antithrombotics, activators of fibrinolysis and antiplatelet agents; thrombin antagonists; factor Xa inhibitors; factor Vila inhibitors); antiplatelet agents (eg. aspirin, clopidogrel); anticoagulants (heparin and Low molecular weight analogues, hirudin) and warfarin; 13) Agents which antagonise the actions of glucagon; and
14) Anti-inflammatory agents, such as non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs (eg. aspirin) and steroidal anti-inflammatory agents (eg. cortisone).
According to another aspect of the present invention there is provided individual compounds produced as end products in the Examples set out below and salts thereof. A compound of the invention, or a salt thereof, may be prepared by any process known to be applicable to the preparation of such compounds or structurally related compounds. Functional groups may be protected and deprotected using conventional methods. For examples of protecting groups such as amino and carboxylic acid protecting groups (as well as means of formation and eventual deprotection), see T. W. Greene and P.G.M. Wuts, "Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis", Second Edition, John Wiley & Sons, New York, 1991.
Processes for the synthesis of compounds of Formula (I) are provided as a further feature of the invention. Thus, according to a further aspect of the invention there is provided a process for the preparation of a compound of Formula (I), which comprises a process a) to g) (wherein the variables are as defined hereinbefore for compounds of Formula (I) unless otherwise defined): (a) reaction of an acid of Formula (V) or activated derivative thereof with a compound of Formula (VI);
Figure imgf000045_0001
(V) (VI); or
(b) reaction of a compound of Formula (VII) with a compound of Formula (VIII),
Figure imgf000045_0002
(VII) (VIII) wherein X1 is a leaving group and X2 is a hydroxyl group or X1 is a hydroxyl group and X2 is a leaving group; process (b) could also be accomplished using the intermediate ester Formula (IX), wherein P1 is a protecting group as hereinafter described, followed by ester hydrolysis and amide formation by procedures described elsewhere and well known to those skilled in the art;
Figure imgf000045_0003
(VII) (IX) or
(c) reaction of a compound of Formula (X) with a compound of Formula (XI):
Figure imgf000046_0001
(X) (XI) wherein X3 is a leaving group or an organometallic reagent and X4 is a hydroxyl group or X3 is a hydroxyl group and X4 is a leaving group or an organometallic reagent; process (c) could also be accomplished using the intermediate ester Formula (XII), followed by ester hydrolysis and amide formation by procedures described elsewhere and well known to those skilled in the art;
Figure imgf000046_0002
(d) reaction of a compound of Formula (XIII) with a compound of Formula (XIV),
Figure imgf000046_0003
(XIII) (XIV); wherein X5 is a leaving group; or e) when A is phenyl or HET-2, by reaction of a compound of formula (XV)
Figure imgf000047_0001
(XV) wherein R2a is a precursor to R2, such as a carboxylic acid, ester or anhydride (for R2 = -CONR4R5) or the sulfonic acid equivalents (for R2 is -SO2NR4R5); with an amine of formula -NR4R5; f) when A is HET-3, by cyclisation of a compound of formula (XVI) to a compound of formula (I)
Figure imgf000047_0002
(XVI) wherein Y1 and Y2 are 0-4 atom linkers, wherein each linker atom is independently selected from C, N, S or O (wherein any C or S can be optionally oxidised and any atom can be optionally substituted provided it is not quaternised and there are no S-S or 0-0 bonds), X6 can be any nucleophilic species and X7 a leaving group or vice versa; process (f) could also be accomplished using the intermediate ester Formula (XVII), followed by ester hydrolysis and amide formation by procedures described elsewhere and well known to those skilled in the art;
Figure imgf000048_0001
(XVII)
(g) reaction of a compound of Formula (XX) with a suitable metal iodide, such as sodium iodide, and a (l-4C)alkylamine or (3-6C)cycloalkylamine, in a suitable solvent, for example acetonitrile, and at a suitable temperature with heating in a microwave, for example 100 to 130°C, more suitably 115 to 125°C;
Figure imgf000048_0002
and thereafter, if necessary: i) converting a compound of Formula (I) into another compound of Formula (I); ii) removing any protecting groups; and/or iii) forming a salt thereof.
Suitable leaving groups X1 to X5 for processes b) to d) are any leaving group known in the art for these types of reactions, for example halo, alkoxy, trifluoromethanesulfonyloxy, methanesulfonyloxy, or p-toluenesulfonyloxy; or a group (such as a hydroxy group) that may be converted into a leaving group (such as an oxytriphenylphosphonium group) in situ.
Suitable values for R1 containing a protected hydroxy group are any suitable protected hydroxy group known in the art, for example simple ethers such as a methyl ether, tert-butyl ether or silylethers such as -OSi[(l-4C)alkyl]3 (wherein each (l-4C)alkyl group is independently selected from methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, and tertbutyl). Examples of such trialkylsilyl groups are trimethylsilyl, triethylsilyl, triisopropylsilyl and tert- butyldimethylsilyl. Further suitable silyl ethers are those containing phenyl and substituted phenyl groups, such as -Si(PhMe2) and -Si(ToIMe2) (wherein ToI = methylbenzene). Further suitable values for hydroxy protecting groups are given hereinafter. Compounds of Formulae (V) to (XIV) are commercially available, or are known in the art, or may be made by processes known in the art, for example as shown in the accompanying Examples, or as described below. For further information on processes for making such compounds, we refer to our PCT publications WO 03/000267, WO 03/015774 and WO 03/000262 and references therein. In general it will be appreciated that any aryl-0 or alkyl-O bond may be formed by nucleophilic substitution or metal catalysed processes, optionally in the presence of a suitable base.
Compounds of Formula (XV) may be made by processes such as those shown in processes a) to d) and/or by those processes mentioned above for compounds of formulae (V) to (XIV). The pyrrolidone group in the compounds of formulae (V), (XI), (XII), (XIII), (XV) and
(XVI) may be made by reaction of suitable precursors with compounds of formula (VII) or derivatives thereof, for example, by nucleophilic displacement of a leaving group X1 in a compound of formula (VII). Compounds of formula (VII) are generally commercially available or maybe made by simple functional group interconversions from commercially available compounds, or by literature methods. Examples of approaches to the pyrrolidone group are outlined in Schemes 1 and 2 below and are further illustrated in the accompanying examples.
Figure imgf000050_0001
(iv)
Figure imgf000050_0002
Scheme 1
Wherein: ring A, HET-I and R1 are as described above and X2 represents a hydroxyl group. Suitable reaction conditions for steps (i) to (v) of Scheme 1 are as follows:
Step (i) proceeds according to the Mitsunobu reaction as is well known in the literature, more specifically, step (i) involves the reaction of a compound of Formula (VlII) with 3- hydroxyoxolan-2-one in the presence of triphenyl phosphine and DIAD, in a suitable solvent, for example anhydrous THF, and at a suitable temperature, for example 0 to 25°C, more suitably 20 to 250C;
Step (ii) involves the reaction of a compound of Formula (XVIII) with a suitable alcohol, for example ethanol, in the presence of a suitable base, for example potassium carbonate, and at a suitable temperature, for example 0 to 25°C, more suitably 20 to 250C;
Step (iii) involves the reaction of a compound fo Formula (XIX) with methanesulfonyl chloride in the presenc of a suitable base, for example triethylamine, in a suitable solvent, for example DCM, and at a suitable temperature, for example 0 to 250C, more suitably 20 to 250C; and
Steps (iv) and (v) involve the reaction of a compound of Formula (XX) with a suitable metal iodide, such as sodium iodide, and a (l-4C)alkylamine or (3-6C)cycloalkylamine, in a suitable solvent, for example acetonitrile, and at a suitable temperature with heating in a microwave, for example 100 to 1300C, more suitably 115 to 125°C.
Figure imgf000051_0001
(XXIII) (XXIV) Scheme 2
Wherein:
R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl. Suitable reaction conditions for steps (i) and (ii) of Scheme 2 are as follows:
Step (i) involves the reaction of 2,4-dibromobutanoyl chloride with a (l-4C)alkylamine or (3-6C)cycloalkylamine in a suitable solvent, such as water and DCM, and at a suitable temperature, for example 0 to 500C, more suitably 10 to 3O0C; and
Step (ii) involves the reaction of a compound of Formula (XXIII) with a suitable base, for example sodium hydride, in a suitable solvent, for example THF, and at a suitable temperature, for example 0 to 300C, more suitably 10 to 15°C.
Examples of conversions of a compound of Formula (I) into another compound of Formula (I), well known to those skilled in the art, include functional group interconversions such as hydrolysis, hydrogenation, hydrogenolysis, oxidation or reduction, and/or further functionalisation by standard reactions such as amide or metal-catalysed coupling, or nucleophilic displacement reactions.
It will be understood that substituents R3, R6 and/or R7 may be introduced into the molecule at any convenient point in the synthetic sequence or may be present in the starting materials. A precursor to one of these substituents may be present in the molecule during the process steps a) to e) above, and then be transformed into the desired substituent as a final step to form the compound of formula (I); followed where necessary by i) converting a compound of Formula (I) into another compound of Formula (I); ii) removing any protecting groups; and/or iii) forming a salt thereof.
Specific reaction conditions for the above reactions are as follows, wherein when P1 is a protecting group P1 is preferably (l-4C)alkyl, for example methyl or ethyl: Process a) - coupling reactions of amino groups with carboxylic acids to form an amide are well known in the art. For example, (i) using an appropriate coupling reaction, such as a carbodiimide coupling reaction performed with EDAC (l-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride) in the presence of dimethylaminopyridine (DMAP) in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane (DCM), chloroform or dimethylformamide (DMF) at room temperature; or (ii) reaction in which the carboxylic group is activated to an acid chloride by reaction with a reagent known for such reactions such as l-chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine in the presence of a suitable solvent such as DCM. The acid chloride can then be reacted with a compound of Formula (VI) in the presence of a base, such as triethylamine or pyridine, in a suitable solvent such as chloroform or DCM at a temperature between O0C and 8O0C. Process b) - compounds of Formula (VII) and (VIII) can be reacted together in a suitable solvent, such as DMF or tetrahydrofuran (THF), with a base such as sodium hydride or potassium tert-butoxide, at a temperature in the range 0 to 2000C, optionally using microwave heating or metal catalysis such as palladium(H)acetate, palladium on carbon, copper(II)acetate or copper(I)iodide; alternatively, compounds of Formula (VII) and (VIII) can be reacted together in a suitable solvent, such as THF or DCM, with a suitable phosphine such as triphenylphosphine, and an azodicarboxylate such as diethylazodicarboxylate; process b) could also be carried out using a precursor to the ester of formula (IX) such as an aryl-nitrile or trifluoromethyl derivative, followed by conversion to a carboxylic acid and amide formation as previously described; Process c) - compounds of Formula (X) and (XI) can be reacted together in a suitable solvent, such as DMF or THF, with a base such as cesium carbonate, sodium hydride or potassium tert-butoxide, at a temperature in the range 0 to 2000C, optionally using microwave heating or metal catalysis such as palladium(II)acetate, palladium on carbon, copper(II)acetate, tris(triphenylphosphine)copper bromide or copper(I)iodide; process c) could also be carried out using a precursor to the ester of formula (XII) such as an aryl-nitrile or trifluoromethyl derivative, followed by conversion to a carboxylic acid and amide formation as previously described; compounds of the formula (X) are commercially available or can be prepared from commercially available materials by processes well known to those skilled in the art, for example functional group interconversions (such as hydrolysis, hydrogenation, hydrogenolysis, oxidation or reduction), and/or further functionalisation and/or cyclisation by standard reactions (such as amide or sulphonamide or metal-catalysed coupling, or nucleophilic displacement or electrophilic substitution reactions); for example, by addition of a formyl group to a hydroxybenzamide compound as shown below:
Figure imgf000053_0001
or by a nucleophilic displacement reaction as shown below:
Figure imgf000053_0002
Process d) - reaction of a compound of Formula (XIII) with a compound of Formula (XIV) can be performed in a polar solvent, such as DMF or a non-polar solvent such as THF with a strong base, such as sodium hydride or potassium fert-butoxide at a temperature between 0 and 2000C, optionally using microwave heating or metal catalysis, such as palladium(II)acetate, palladium on carbon, copper(II)acetate or copper(I)iodide; Process e) - coupling reactions of amino groups with carboxylic or sulfonic acids or acid derivatives to form an amide are well known in the art and are described above for Process a). Process f) - cyclisations of a compound of formula (XVI) to a compound of formula (I) are well known in the art; for example, i) a coupling reaction of amino groups with carboxylic acids using coupling reagents or acid chlorides (see process a) to form amide bonds; ii) a coupling reaction of an amino group with a sulphonyl chloride in the presence of a suitable base, such as pyridine or triethylamine, in a suitable solvent such as DCM, toluene or pyridine at a temperature between O0C and 8O0C, to form a sulphonamide group; iii) reaction with a suitable solvent, such as DMF or tetrahydrofuran (THF), with a base such as sodium hydride or potassium tert-butoxide, at a temperature in the range 0 to 2000C, optionally using microwave heating or metal catalysis such as palladium(II)acetate, palladium on carbon, copper(II)acetate or copper(I)iodide; alternatively, reaction in a suitable solvent, such as THF or DCM, with a suitable phosphine such as triphenylphosphine, and azodicarboxylate such as diethylazodicarboxylate; iv) electrophilic substitution reactions (such as Friedel Crafts reactions, for compounds of
Formula (XVI) where either Y1 is a direct bond and X6 = H or Y2 is a direct bond and X7 is
H); compounds of the Formula (XVI) may be made from compounds of Formula (XVII), wherein each R group is independently a simple substituent (such as halo or cyano) or hydrogen, by processes well known to those skilled in the art such as functional group interconversions (for example hydrolysis, hydrogenation, hydrogenolysis, oxidation or reduction), and/or further functionalisation by standard reactions (such as amide or sulphonamide or metal-catalysed coupling, or nucleophilic displacement or electrophilic substitution reactions); compounds of formula (XVII) may be made from commercially available materials by processes such as those described herein in processes a) to e).
Figure imgf000054_0001
(XVII)
It will be appreciated that it is possible to form Ring C from a pre-cursor and form the phenoxy link in a one-pot reaction, so that it is unclear whether process c) or process e) is actually the final step. This is illustrated in the scheme below (for Ring B = phenyl) which illustrates that the SnAr reaction, deprotection and cyclisation to form Ring C may occur in the same reaction pot:
105 min
Figure imgf000055_0001
Figure imgf000055_0002
Rearrangement of Ring C may also occur in some circumstances, for example it may occur in the following circumstances:
Figure imgf000055_0003
Certain intermediates of formula (V), (VII), (XI), (XII), (XIII), (XV), (XVI) and/or (XVII) wherein R1 is as defined herein for a compound of formula (I) are believed to be novel and comprise an independent aspect of the invention. During the preparation process, it may be advantageous to use a protecting group for a functional group within the molecule. Protecting groups may be removed by any convenient method as described in the literature or known to the skilled chemist as appropriate for the removal of the protecting group in question, such methods being chosen so as to effect removal of the protecting group with minimum disturbance of groups elsewhere in the molecule.
Specific examples of protecting groups are given below for the sake of convenience, in which "lower" signifies that the group to which it is applied preferably has 1-4 carbon atoms. It will be understood that these examples are not exhaustive. Where specific examples of methods for the removal of protecting groups are given below these are similarly not exhaustive. The use of protecting groups and methods of deprotection not specifically mentioned is of course within the scope of the invention.
A carboxy protecting group may be the residue of an ester-forming aliphatic or araliphatic alcohol or of an ester-forming silanol (the said alcohol or silanol preferably containing 1-20 carbon atoms). Examples of carboxy protecting groups include straight or branched chain (l-12C)alkyl groups (e.g. isopropyl, t-butyl); lower alkoxy lower alkyl groups (e.g. methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, isobutoxymethyl); lower aliphatic acyloxy lower alkyl groups, (e.g. acetoxymethyl, propionyloxymethyl, butyryloxymethyl, pivaloyloxymethyl); lower alkoxycarbonyloxy lower alkyl groups (e.g. 1-methoxycarbonyloxy ethyl,
1-ethoxycarbonyloxyethyl); aryl lower alkyl groups (e.g. β-methoxybenzyl, o-nitrobenzyl, p_-nitrobenzyl, benzhydryl and phthalidyl); tri(lower alkyl)silyl groups (e.g. trimethylsilyl and t-butyldimethylsilyl); tri(lower alkyl)silyl lower alkyl groups (e.g. trimethylsilylethyl); and (2-6C)alkenyl groups (e.g. allyl and vinylethyl). Methods particularly appropriate for the removal of carboxyl protecting groups include for example acid-, metal- or enzymically-catalysed hydrolysis. Hydrogenation may also be used.
Examples of hydroxy protecting groups include methyl, t-butyl, lower alkenyl groups (e.g. allyl); lower alkanoyl groups (e.g. acetyl); lower alkoxycarbonyl groups (e.g. t-butoxycarbonyl); lower alkenyloxycarbonyl groups (e.g. allyloxycarbonyl); aryl lower alkoxycarbonyl groups (e.g. benzoyloxycarbonyl, rj-methoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, o-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, rj-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl); tri lower alkyl/arylsilyl groups (e.g. trimethylsilyl, t-butyldimethylsilyl, t-butyldiphenylsilyl); tetrahydropyran-2-yl; aryl lower alkyl groups (e.g. benzyl) groups; and triaryl lower alkyl groups (e.g. triphenylmethyl). Examples of amino protecting groups include formyl, aralkyl groups (e.g. benzyl and substituted benzyl, e.g. D.-methoxybenzyl, nitrobenzyl and 2,4-dimethoxybenzyl, and triphenylmethyl); di-p_-anisylmethyl and furylmethyl groups; lower alkoxycarbonyl (e.g. t-butoxycarbonyl); lower alkenyloxycarbonyl (e.g. allyloxycarbonyl); aryl lower alkoxycarbonyl groups (e.g. benzyloxycarbonyl, p_-methoxybenzyloxycarbonyl, o-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, p_-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl; trialkylsilyl (e.g. trimethylsilyl and t-butyldimethylsilyl); alkylidene (e.g. methylidene); benzylidene and substituted benzylidene groups.
Methods appropriate for removal of hydroxy and amino protecting groups include, for example, hydrogenation, nucleophilic displacement, acid-, base, metal- or enzymically-catalysed hydrolysis, catalytic hydrogenolysis or photolytically for groups such as o-nitrobenzyloxycarbonyl, or with fluoride ions for silyl groups. For example, methylether protecting groups for hydroxy groups may be removed by trimethylsilyliodide. A tert-butyl ether protecting group for a hydroxy group may be removed by hydrolysis, for example by use of hydrochloric acid in methanol.
Examples of protecting groups for amide groups include aralkoxymethyl (e.g. benzyloxymethyl and substituted benzyloxymethyl); alkoxymethyl (e.g. methoxymethyl and trimethylsilylethoxymethyl); tri alkyl/arylsilyl (e.g. trimethylsilyl, t-butyldimethylsily, t- butyldiphenylsilyl); tri alkyl/arylsilyloxymethyl (e.g. t-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl, t-butyldiphenylsilyloxymethyl); 4-alkoxyphenyl (e.g. 4-methoxyphenyl); 2,4- di(alkoxy)phenyl (e.g. 2,4-dimethoxyphenyl); 4-alkoxybenzyl (e.g. 4-methoxybenzyl); 2,4- di(alkoxy)benzyl (e.g. 2,4-di(methoxy)benzyl); and alk-1-enyl (e.g. allyl, but-1-enyl and substituted vinyl e.g. 2-phenylvinyl).
Aralkoxymethyl, groups may be introduced onto the amide group by reacting the latter group with the appropriate aralkoxymethyl chloride, and removed by catalytic hydrogenation. Alkoxymethyl, tri alkyl/arylsilyl and tri alkyl/silyloxymethyl groups may be introduced by reacting the amide with the appropriate chloride and removing with acid; or in the case of the silyl containing groups, fluoride ions. The alkoxyphenyl and alkoxybenzyl groups are conveniently introduced by arylation or alkylation with an appropriate halide and removed by oxidation with eerie ammonium nitrate. Finally alk-1-enyl groups may be introduced by reacting the amide with the appropriate aldehyde and removed with acid.
In the above other pharmaceutical composition, process, method, use and medicament manufacture features, the alternative and preferred aspects and embodiments of the compounds of the invention described herein also apply.
The following examples are for illustration purposes and are not intended to limit the scope of this application. Each exemplified compound represents a particular and independent aspect of the invention. In the following non-limiting Examples, unless otherwise stated:
(i) evaporations were carried out by rotary evaporation under reduced pressure and work-up procedures were carried out after removal of residual solids such as drying agents by filtration;
(ii) operations were carried out at room temperature, that is in the range 18-25°C and under an atmosphere of an inert gas such as argon or nitrogen;
(iii) yields are given for illustration only and are not necessarily the maximum attainable; (iv) the structures of the end-products of the Formula (I) were confirmed by nuclear (generally proton) magnetic resonance (NMR) and mass spectral techniques; proton magnetic resonance chemical shift values were measured on the delta scale and peak multiplicities are shown as follows: s, singlet; d, doublet; t, triplet; m, multiplet; br, broad; q, quartet, quin, quintet;
(v) intermediates were not generally fully characterised and purity was assessed by thin layer chromatography (TLC), high-performance liquid chromatography (HPLC), infra-red (IR) or NMR analysis;
(vi) flash chromatography was carried out on silica unless otherwise stated.
Abbreviations
DCM dichloromethane;
DEAD diethylazodicarboxylate;
DMA dimethylacetamide DIAD diisopropylazodicarboxylate;
DMSO dimethyl sulphoxide;
DMF dimethylformamide;
EDAC 1 -(3 -dimethylaminopropy l)-3 -ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride; HPLC high pressure liquid chromatography
HPMC Hydroxypropylmethylcellulose;
LCMS liquid chromatography / mass spectroscopy;
NMR nuclear magnetic resonance spectroscopy
RT room temperature; and THF tetrahydrofuran Example 1: 3-16-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-ylloxy-5-f(3SVl-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yDbenzamide
Figure imgf000059_0001
3 - [6-(Azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 -hydroxy-N-(5 -methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide (442 mg, 1.1 mmol) (Intermediate 1) and 3-bromo-l-methyl-pyrrolidin-2-one (Intermediate 4) (385 mg, 2.2 mmol) were dissolved in DMF and treated with potassium carbonate (377 mg, 2.7 mmol) and stirred at room temperature for 21 hours. The DMF was evaporated, the residue partitioned between ethyl acetate (90 mL) and water (20 rnL). The organic layer was separated, washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and evaporated to give an oil which was purified by chromatography on silica eluting with 0-6% methanol in DCM to give the racemic product (420 mg). 3-[6-(Azetidme-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using a Merck 50mm 20μm Chiralcel OJ No. CEOOl column eluting with methanol at a flow rate of 50 mL/min; 420 mg of racemic material was separated in 3 injections of 15 mL at 11 mg/ml in 1:1:1 acetonitrile/ethanol/rnethanol to afford the product (179 mg, 32%) which eluted after its enantiomer. 1H NMR δ (400 MHz, CDCl3): 2.08 - 2.18 (m, IH), 2.28 (quintet, 2H), 2.47 - 2.57 (m, IH), 2.48 (s, 3H), 2.86 (s, 3H), 3.29 - 3.37 (m, IH), 3.42 - 3.48 (m, IH), 4.18 (t, 2H), 4.64 (t, 2H), 4.86 (t, IH), 6.91 (s, IH), 7.14 (s, IH), 7.32 (d, IH), 7.39 (s, IH), 8.05 (d, IH), 8.07 (s, IH), 8.26 (s, IH), 8.37 (s, IH), 9.45 (s, IH); m/z 503 (M+H)+ Example 2: 3-f6-(Azetidine-l-earbonvDpyridin-3-ylloxy-5-f(3RVl-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vDbenzamide
Figure imgf000060_0001
3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-liydroxy-N-(5-metliylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide (442 mg, 1.1 mmol) (Intermediate 1) and 3-bromo-l-methyl-pyrrolidin-2-one (385 mg, 2.2 mmol) (Intermediate 4) were dissolved in DMF and treated with potassium carbonate (377 mg, 2.7 mmol) and stirred at room temperature for 21 hours. The DMF was evaporated, the residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate (90 mL) and water (20 mL). The organic layer was separated, washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and evaporated to give an oil which was purified by chromatography on silica eluting with 0-6% methanol in DCM to give the racemic product (420 mg). 3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)-l-methyl-2- oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using a Merck 50mm 20μm Chiralcel OJ No. CEOOl column eluting with methanol at a flow rate of 50 mL/min; 420 mg of racemic material was separated in 3 injections of 15 mL at 11 mg/ml in 1:1:1 acetonitrile/ethanol/methanol to afford the product (187 mg, 33%) which eluted before its enantiomer. 1H NMR δ (400 MHz, CDCl3): 2.08 - 2.18 (m, IH), 2.28 (quintet, 2H), 2.47 - 2.57 (m, IH), 2.48 (s, 3H), 2.86 (s, 3H), 3.29 - 3.37 (m, IH), 3.42 - 3.48 (m, IH), 4.18 (t, 2H), 4.64 (t, 2H), 4.86 (t, IH), 6.91 (s, IH), 7.14 (s, IH), 7.32 (d, IH), 7.39 (s, IH), 8.05 (d, IH), 8.07 (s, IH), 8.26 (s, IH), 8.37 (s, IH), 9.45 (s, IH); m/z 503 (M+H)+
Example 3: 3-[5-(Azetidine-l-carbonvDpyrazin-2-yl]oxy-5-f(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-vUoxy-N-(4-methyll,3-thiazol-2-v0benzamide
Figure imgf000060_0002
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (0.10 mL, 0.75 mmol) was added to a solution of the 3 - [5 -(azetidine- 1 -carbony l)pyrazin-2-yl] oxy-5 - [(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrroli din-3 - yl]oxy-benzoic acid (Intermediate 6) (265 mg, 0.62 mmol) in DCM (5 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 30 minutes, a further aliquot of l-chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l-en- 1-amine (0.10 mL) was added and stirring continued for a further 30 minutes. 4-Methyl-l,3- thiazol-2-amine (142 mg, 1.2 mmol) and pyridine (0.10 mL, 1.2 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred for 16 hours. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (15 mL) and DCM (15 mL), washed with water (2x10 mL) and brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated under reduced pressure to give the crude product which was purified by flash chromatography on silica, eluting with a gradient of 0-5% methanol in DCM, to afford the product (181 mg, 58%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.10 - 2.26 (m, 4H), 2.38 (quintet, 2H), 2.50 - 2.63 (m, IH), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.33 - 3.56 (m, 2H), 4.26 (t, 2H), 4.69 (t, 2H), 4.84 (t, IH), 6.54 (s, IH), 7.15 (s, IH), 7.36 (s, IH), 7.53 (s, IH), 8.32 (s, IH), 8.82 (s, IH), 10.43 (s, IH); m/z 509 (M+H)+
Example 4: 3-f5-(Azetidme-l-carbonyl)pyrazin-2-vUoxy-5-[(3R)-l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(4-methyll,3-thiazol-2-vDbenzamide
Figure imgf000061_0001
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1-amine (0.16 mL, 1.2 mmol) was added to a solution of 3-[5-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyrazin-2-yl]oxy-5-(l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl)oxy-benzoic acid (Intermediate 10) (288 mg, 0.68 mmol) in DCM (5 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 30 minutes. 4-Methyl-l,3-thiazol-2-amine (156 mg, 1.36 mmol) and pyridine (0.11 mL, 1.4 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred for 16 hours. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue dissolved in ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with water (2x10 mL) and brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica, eluting with a gradient of 0-5% methanol in DCM, to afford the product (117 mg, 34%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.10 - 2.26 (m, 4H), 2.38 (quintet, 2H), 2.50 - 2.63 (m, IH), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.33 3.56 (m, 2H), 4.26 (t, 2H), 4.69 (t, 2H), 4.84 (t, IH), 6.54 (s, IH), 7.15 (s, IH), 7.36 (s, IH), 7.53 (s, IH), 8.32 (s, IH), 8.82 (s, IH), 10.43 (s, IH); m/z 509 (M+H)+
Example 5: 3-[4-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)phenoxyl-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- ylloxy-N-(lH-pyrazol-3-vDbenzamide
Figure imgf000062_0001
Tert-butyl 3-[[3-[4-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)phenoxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- yl]oxy-benzoyl]amino]pyrazole-l-carboxylate (Intermediate 14) (388 mg, 0.67 mmol) was dissolved in acetonitrile (5 mL) and heated in a microwave for 12 minutes at 1500C, the solution was concentrated under reduced pressure to afford the product (261 mg, 82%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.06 - 2.21 (m, IH), 2.34 (quintet, 2H), 2.49 - 2.63 (m, IH), 2.92 (s, 3H), 3.31 - 3.52 (m, 2H), 4.15 - 4.38 (m, 4H), 4.87 (t, IH), 6.77 (s, IH), 6.80 (s, IH), 6.98 (d, 2H), 7.17 (s, IH), 7.38 (s, IH), 7.48 (s, IH), 7.61 (d, 2H), 10.29 (s, IH); m/z 476 (M+H)+.
Example 6: 3-f5-(Azetidine-l-carbonvπ-3-chIoro-pyridin-2-ylloxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2- oxo-PVrrolidin-3-vπoxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide
Figure imgf000062_0002
A mixture of 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (136 mg, 0.4 mmol), azetidin-l-yl-(5,6-dichloropyridin-3- yl)methanone (Intermediate 21) (103 mg, 0.44 mmol) and potassium carbonate (111 mg, 0.8 mmol) in DMA (5 mL) was stirred at 120°C for 2 hours. The solution was evaporated under reduced pressure, the residue dissolved in ethyl acetate (40 mL) washed with water (2x20 mL), brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica, eluting with a gradient of 0-4% methanol in DCM to afford the product (188 mg, 87%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.16 - 2.29 (m, IH), 2.40 (quintet, 2H), 2.50 - 2.72 (m, 4H), 2.95 (s, 3H), 3.36 - 3.58 (m, 2H), 4.18 - 4.42 (m, 4H), 4.95 (t, IH), 7.15 (s, IH), 7.37 (s, IH), 7.55 (s, IH), 8.15 (s, 2H), 8.25 (s, IH), 8.55 (s, IH), 9.54 (s, IH); m/z 537 (M+H)+.
Example 7: 3-l(3SVl-Methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl1 oxy-N-(5-methyIpyrazin-2-yl)-5-(4- methylsulfbnylphenoxytbenzamide
Figure imgf000063_0001
A mixture of 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (136 mg, 0.4 mmol), l-fluoro-4-methylsulfonyl-benzene (105 mg, 0.6 mmol) and potassium carbonate (111 mg, 0.8 mmol) in DMA (5 mL) was stirred at 120°C for 2 hours. The solution was evaporated under reduced pressure, the residue dissolved in ethyl acetate (40 mL), washed with water (2x20 mL), brine(20 mL), dried
(MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica, eluting with a gradient of 0-4% methanol in DCM to afford product (135 mg, 68%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.15 - 2.30 (m, IH), 2.53 - 2.69 (m, 4H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.08 (s, 3H), 3.36 - 3.58 (m, 2H), 4.96 (t, IH), 7.02 (s, IH), 7.15 (d, 2H), 7.25 (s, IH), 7.50 (s, IH), 7.93 (d, 2H), 8.15 (s, IH), 8.55 (s, IH), 9.53 (s, IH); m/z 497 (M+H)+.
Example 8: S-M-tAzetidine-l-carbonyQphenoxyl-S-rDSVl-methyl-^-oxo-pyrrolidin-S- ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vDbenzamide
Figure imgf000064_0001
A solution of 3-[4-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)-2-chloro-phenoxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-metliylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide (Intermediate 22) (120 mg, 0.22 mmol) and 10% palladium on carbon (20 mg, catalytic) in THF (5 niL) and ethanol (5 mL) was stirred under an atmosphere of hydrogen for 16 hours. The palladium on carbon was removed by filtration and the filtrate evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with water (10 mL), brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated under reduced pressure to give product (98 mg, 89%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.12 - 2.26 (m, IH), 2.36 (quintet, 2H), 2.52 - 2.67 (m, 4H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.35 - 3.57 (m, 2H), 4.19 - 4.42 (m, 4H), 4.93 (t, IH), 6.93 (s, IH), 7.03 (d, 2H), 7.20 (s, IH), 7.42 (s, IH), 7.66 (d, 2H), 8.15 (s, IH), 8.54 (s, IH), 9.52 (s, IH); m/z 502 (M+H)+.
Example 9; 3-f(2,2-Dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicycIo[5.4.01undeca-7,9.,ll-trien-9-yl)oxyl-5- [f3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vπbenzamide
Figure imgf000064_0002
3-Hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (171 mg, 0.5 mmol), 9-fluoro-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-7,9,ll- triene 2,2-dioxide (Intermediate 23) (130 mg, 0.6 mmol) and potassium carbonate (139 mg, 1 mmol) in acetonitrile (5 mL) were heated in a microwave at 16O0C for 5 hours. The precipitate was filtered and purified by column chromatography on silica eluting with 0-4% methanol/DCM to give product (204 mg, 76%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.13 - 2.28 (m, IH), 2.37 - 2.48 (m, 2H), 2.53 - 2.68 (m, 4H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.31 - 3.57 (m, 4H), 4.26 (t, 2H), 4.94 (t, IH), 6.76 (s, IH), 6.87 (d, IH), 6.99 (s, IH), 7.24 (s, IH), 7.50 (s, IH), 7.93 (d, IH), 8.13 (s, IH), 8.55 (s, IH), 9.52 (s, IH); m/z 539 (M+H)+.
Example 10: S-fό-fAzetidine-l-carbonvOpyridin-S-ylloxy-S-d-ethyl-Σ-oxo-pyrroIidin-S- yl)oxy-N-(5-methyIpyrazin-2-vDbenzamide
Figure imgf000065_0001
Ethyl 2-[3-[6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridm-3-yl]oxy-5-[(5-methylpyrazm-2- yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]-4-methylsulfonyloxy-butanoate (Intermediate 27) (27 nig, 0.04 mmol), sodium iodide (7 mg, 0.04 nimol) and ethylamine (2M in THF; 45 μL, 0.09 mmol) in acetonitrile (2 niL) were heated in a microwave at 120°C for 90 minutes. Solvent evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue diluted with ethyl acetate (20 niL) and brine (20 mL). The organics were separated and the aqueous layer re-extracted with ethyl acetate (20 mL). The combined organics were dried (MgSO4) and concentrated and the residue purified by preparative HPLC, eluting with a gradient of 5 to 95% acetonitrile in water containing 0.2% trifluoroacetic acid on a Phenomenex Luna 1Ou C 18(2) IOOA column, to afford product (24 mg, 87%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3)1.19 (3H, t), 2.17 - 2.26 (IH, m), 2.34 - 2.44 (2H, m), 2.62 - 2.74 (4H, m), 3.39 - 3.59 (4H, m), 4.30 (2H, s), 4.76 (2H, s), 5.11 (IH, t), 6.95 (IH, t), 7.29 (IH, t), 7.39 - 7.42 (IH, m), 7.52 (IH, d), 8.10 (IH, d), 8.19 (IH, s), 8.36 (IH, d), 9.65 (lH, d); m/z 517 (M+H)+.
Example 11: 3-f(5-methyl-6.,6-dioxo-2-oxa-6-λ6-thia-5-azabicvclor5.4.01undeca-8,10Λ2- trien-10-yl)oxyl-5-(l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-vL)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yDbenzamide
Figure imgf000066_0001
3-Hydroxy-5-(l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (0.279 g, 0.82 mmol), 10-fluoro-5-methyl-2-oxa-6-λ6-thia-5- azabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8,10,12-triene 6,6-dioxide (Intermediate 35) (0.227 g, 0.98 mmol) and potassium carbonate (0.226 g, 1.63 mmol) were dissolved in acetonitrile (5 mL) and heated in a microwave at 160 0C for 10 hours. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and water (20 mL) and ethyl acetate (50 mL) was added. The ethyl acetate layer was separated, washed with brine (50 mL), dried (MgSO4) and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by chromatography on silica eluting with 0-4% methanol/DCM to give product (253 mg, 56%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.14 - 2.29 (m, IH), 2.54 - 2.67 (m, 4H), 2.82 (s, 3H), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.35 - 3.58 (m, 2H), 3.74 (t, 2H), 4.21 (t, 2H), 4.94 (t, IH), 6.76 (s, IH), 6.84 (d, IH), 6.99 (s, IH), 7.25 (s, IH), 7.49 (s, IH), 7.79 (d, IH), 8.14 (s, IH), 8.53 (s, IH), 9.53 (s, IH); m/z 554 (M+H)+.
Example 12: S-fό-fAzetidine-l-carbonvOpyridin-S-ylloxy-S-fOSVl-methyl-l-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-pyrazin-2-yl-benzamide
Figure imgf000066_0002
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (0.08 OmL, 0.60 mmol) was added to a solution of 3 - [6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 - [(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl] oxy- benzoic acid (Intermediate 30) (202 mg, 0.49 mmol) in DCM (5 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 50 minutes. 2-Amino-pyrazine (CAS no. 5049-61-6) (94 mg, 0.98 mmol) and pyridine (0.80 mL, 0.98 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred for 16 hours. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue taken up in ethyl acetate (40 mL), washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate (20 mL), water (10 mL), and brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure to give the crude product. The residue was purified by chromatography on silica, eluting with a gradient of 0-4% methanol in DCM to give product (53 mg, 22%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.13 - 2.27 (m, IH), 2.35 (quintet, 2H), 2.52 - 2.67 (m, IH), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.34 - 3.59 (m, 2H), 4.24 (t, 2H), 4.70 (t, 2H), 4.94 (t, IH), 6.98 (s, IH), 7.23 (s, IH), 7.39 (d, IH), 7.48 (s, IH), 8.12 (d, IH), 8.27 (q, IH), 8.33 (d, IH), 8.39 (d, IH), 8.66 (s, IH), 9.66 (s, IH); m/z 489 (M+H)+.
Example 13: 3-f6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl')pyridin-3-ylloxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrroIidin-3-ylloxy-N-pyridin-2-yl-benzamide
Figure imgf000067_0001
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (0.077 mL, 0.58 mmol) was added to a solution of 3 - [6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 - [(3S)-I -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl] oxy- benzoic acid (Intermediate 30) (200 mg, 0.49 mmol) in DCM (5 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 50 minutes. 2-Amino-pyridine (93 mg, 0.98 mmol) and pyridine (0.080 mL, 0.98 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred for 16 hours. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (40 mL), washed with water (10 mL), and brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography, eluting with a gradient of 0-100% methanol in DCM to afford the product (112 mg, 47%). 1R NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.12 - 2.26 (m, IH), 2.35 (quintet, 2H), 2.53 - 2.66 (m, IH), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.34 - 3.57 (m, 2H), 4.25 (t, 2H), 4.70 (t, 2H), 4.93 (t, IH), 6.97 (s, IH), 7.08 (t, IH), 7.22 (s, IH), 7.38 (d, IH), 7.45 (s, IH), 7.75 (t, IH), 8.11 (d, IH), 8.29 (d, IH), 8.33 (q, 2H), 8.68 (s, IH); m/z 488 (M+H)+. Example 14: 3-f(ll-Chloro-5-methyl-6-oxo-2-oxa-5-azabicvclof5.4.01undeca-8.10.12- trien-10-yl)oxyl-5-f(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- vDbenzamide
Figure imgf000068_0001
A mixture of 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (137 nig, 0.4 mmol), 3-chloro-2,4-difluoro-N-(2- hydroxyethyl)-N-methyl-benzamide (Intermediate 37) (151 mg, 0.6 mmol) and potassium carbonate (111 mg, 0.8 mmol) in acetonitrile (5 mL) was stirred at 16O0C for 6 hours. The solution was evaporated under reduced pressure, the residue dissolved in ethyl acetate (40 mL) washed with water (2x20 mL), brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by chromatography on silica eluting with 0- 4%% methanol/DCM to afford the crude product which was taken up in ethyl acetate and washed with 0.5N hydrochloric acid, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford the product (50 mg, 23%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.12 - 2.25 (m, IH), 2.52 - 2.66 (m, 4H), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.24 (s, 3H), 3.35 - 3.55 (m, 2H), 3.59 (t, 2H), 4.54 (t, 2H), 4.92 (t, IH), 6.83 (d, IH), 6.90 (s, IH), 7.17 (s, IH), 7.41 (s, IH), 7.71 (d, IH), 8.13 (s, IH), 8.52 (s, IH), 9.52 (s, IH); m/z 552 (M+H)+.
Example 15: 3-[(4-Methyl-5-oxo-2-oxa-4-azabicycIo[4.4.01deca-6.,8,10-trien-9-yl)oxyl-5- (l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vDbenzamide
Figure imgf000068_0002
A mixture of 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (279 mg, 0.82 mmol), 9-fluoro-4-methyl-2-oxa-4- azabicyclo[4.4.0]deca-7,9,ll-trien-5-one (Intermediate 38) (163 mg, 0.9 mmol) and potassium carbonate (226 mg, 1.63 mmol) in acetonitrile (10 mL) was heated in a microwave at 16O0C for 12 hours. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure, ethyl acetate (50 mL) was added and the resulting mixture was washed with water (2x20 mL), 0.5N hydrochloric acid (5 mL), water (10 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by chromatography on silica eluting with 0- 4% methanol in DCM to give product (138 mg, 33%). 1Pi NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.13 - 2.28 (m, IH), 2.53 - 2.68 (m, 4H), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.10 (s, 3H), 3.35 - 3.57 (m, 2H), 4.93 (t, IH), 5.17 (s, 2H), 6.54 (s, IH), 6.75 (d, IH), 6.97 (s, IH), 7.21 (s, IH), 7.46 (s, IH), 7.94 (d, IH), 8.14 (s, IH), 8.50 (s, IH), 9.52 (s, IH); m/z 504 (M+H)+.
Example 16; S-KS-Methyl-β-oxo-l-oxa-S-azabicvclofS^.Olundeca-SΛOΛI-trien-lO- vπoxyl-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-v0benzamide
Figure imgf000069_0001
To a solution of 3-[(l l-chloro-5-methyl-6-oxo-2-oxa-5-azabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8,10,12- trien-10-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Example 14, 50 mg, 0.09 mmol) in ethanol (5 mL) was added ammonium formate (57 mg, 0.90 mmol) followed by 10% palladium on carbon (10 mg, catalytic) was added. The mixture was heated to 14O0C for 60 minutes in a microwave. The catalyst was filtered off and the volatiles removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with water (10 mL), 0.5N hydrochloric acid (5 mL), saturated sodium bicarbonate (5 mL) and brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 4% methanol in DCM to afford the product (18 mg, 39%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.11 - 2.26 (m, IH), 2.53 - 2.67 (m, 4H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.21 (s, 3H), 3.35 - 3.55 (m, 2H), 3.58 (t, 2H), 4.41 (t, 2H), 4.94 (t, IH), 6.59 (s, IH), 6.78 (d, IH), 6.95 (s, IH), 7.23 (s, IH), 7.44 (s, IH), 7.88 (d, IH), 8.13 (s, IH), 8.66 (s, IH), 9.53 (s, IH); m/z 518 (M+H)+.
Example 17: S^ό-fAzetidine-l-carbonvOpyridin-θ-ylloxy-S-il-cvcIobutyl^-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-vDoxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yr)benzamide
Figure imgf000070_0001
To a solution of ethyl 2-[3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]-4-methylsulfonyloxy-butanoate (Intermediate 27) (250 mg, 0.41 mmol) in acetonitrile (5 niL), was added sodium iodide (62 mg, 0.41 mmol) and cyclobutylamine (70 μL, 0.81 mmol). The resulting mixture was heated in a microwave at 1200C for 60 minutes. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue purified by flash chromatography eluting with 0-40% methanol in DCM to afford the product (95 mg, 43%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 1.69 - 1.78 (2H, m), 2.13 - 2.23 (5H, m), 2.30 - 2.40 (2H, m), 2.55 - 2.64 (4H, m), 3.39 - 3.47 (IH, m), 3.57 - 3.64 (IH, m), 4.24 (2H t), 4.62 - 4.72 (3H, m), 4.91 - 4.96 (IH, m), 6.96 (IH, t), 7.22 (IH t), 7.36 - 7.40 (IH, m), 7.45 (IH, t), 8.09 - 8.13 (2H, m), 8.32 (IH, d), 8.61 (IH, s), 9.51 (IH, d); m/z 543 (M+H)+.
Example 18: S-fό-fAzetidine-l-carbonvOpyridin-S-ylloxy-S^ORVl-cvclopropyl-Σ-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-vHoxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vπbenzamide
Figure imgf000070_0002
To a solution of ethyl 2-[3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]-4-methylsulfonyloxy-butanoate (Intermediate 27) (250 mg, 0.41 mmol) in acetonitrile (5 niL), was added NaI (62 mg, 0.41 mmol) and cyclopropylamine (56 μL, 0.81 mmol). The resulting mixture was heated in a microwave at 12O°C for 60 minutes. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue purified by flash chromatography eluting with 0-40% methanol in DCM to afford the racemic product (91 mg, 42%). 3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)-l-cyclopropyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin- 3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using a Merck 50mm 20μm Chiralcel OJ column eluting with methanol at a flow rate of 60 mL/min. 91 mg of racemic material was separated in 1 injection of 5 rnL at 18 mg/ml in methanol to afford the product which eluted before its enantiomer (27 mg, 12%). ^H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 0.66 - 0.91 (m, 4H), 2.14 (sextet, IH), 2.35 (quintet, 2H), 2.48 - 2.62 (m, 4H), 2.66 - 2.78 (m, IH), 3.27 - 3.49 (m, 2H), 4.25 (t, 2H), 4.70 (t, 2H), 4.92 (t, IH), 6.96 (s, IH), 7.22 (s, IH), 7.38 (d, IH), 7.45 (s, IH), 8.11 (d, IH), 8.13 (s, IH), 8.33 (s, IH), 8.57 (s, IH), 9.51 (s, IH); m/z 529 (M+H)+.
Example 19: 3-f6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-ylloxy-5-K3S')-l-cvclopropyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vI)benzamide
Figure imgf000071_0001
To a solution of ethyl 2-[3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]-4-methylsulfonyloxy-butanoate (Intermediate 27) (250 mg, 0.41 mmol) in acetonitrile (5 mL), was added NaI (62 mg, 0.41 mmol) and cyclopropylamine (56 μL, 0.81 mmol). The resulting mixture was heated in a microwave at 120°C for 60 minutes. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue purified by flash chromatography eluting with 0-40% methanol in DCM to afford the racemic product (91 mg, 42%). 3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-cyclopropyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin- 3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yi)benzamide was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using a Merck 50mm 20μm Chiralcel OJ column eluting with methanol at a flow rate of 60 mL/min. 91 mg of racemic material was separated in 1 injection of 5 mL at 18 mg/ml in methanol to afford the product which eluted after its enantiomer (29 mg, 13%). *H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 0.66 - 0.91 (m, 4H), 2.14 (sextet, IH), 2.35 (quintet, 2H), 2.48 - 2.62 (m, 4H), 2.66 - 2.78 (m, IH), 3.27 - 3.49 (m, 2H), 4.25 (t, 2H), 4.70 (t, 2H), 4.92 (t, IH), 6.96 (s, IH), 7.22 (s, IH), 7.38 (d, IH), 7.45 (s, IH), 8.11 (d, IH), 8.13 (s, IH), 8.33 (s, IH), 8.57 (s, IH), 9.51 (s, IH); m/z 529 (M+H)+.
Example 20: 3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyr)pyridin-3-yll oxy-5-r(3RVl-cvclobutyl-2-oxo- pyrroϋdin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide
Figure imgf000072_0001
From racemic 3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-(l-cyclobutyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin- 3-yl)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide (Example 17), 3-[6-(azetidine-l- carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 - [(3R)-I -cyclobutyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl]oxy-N-(5 - methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using a Merck 50mm 20μm Chiralcel OJ column eluting with methanol at a flow rate of 60 mL/min. 97 mg of racemic material was separated in 1 injection of 5 mL at 20 mg/ml in methanol to afford the product which eluted before its enantiomer to afford the product (50 mg, 47%).
1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 1.69 - 1.78 (2H, m), 2.13 - 2.23 (5H, m), 2.30 - 2.40 (2H, m), 2.55 - 2.64 (4H, m), 3.39 - 3.47 (IH, m), 3.57 - 3.64 (IH, m), 4.24 (2H t), 4.62 - 4.72 (3H, m), 4.91 - 4.96 (IH, m), 6.96 (IH, t), 7.22 (IH t), 7.36 - 7.40 (IH, m), 7.45 (IH, t), 8.09 - 8.13 (2H, m), 8.32 (IH, d), 8.61 (IH, s), 9.51 (IH, d); m/z 543 (M+H)+.
Example 21: S-fό-fAzetidine-l-carbonvDpyridin-S-vπoxy-S-fOS^-l-cyclobutvL-l-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yr)benzamide
Figure imgf000073_0001
From racemic 3 - [6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 -( 1 -cyclobutyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin- 3-yl)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide (Example 17), 3-[6-(azetidine-l- carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-cyclobutyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using a Merck 50mm 20μm Chiralcel OJ column eluting with methanol at a flow rate of 60 mL/min. 97 mg of racemic material was separated in 1 injection of 5 mL at 20 mg/ml in methanol to afford the product which eluted after its enantiomer to afford the product (47 mg, 44%). 1 H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 1.69 - 1.78 (2H, m), 2.13 - 2.23 (5H, m), 2.30 - 2.40 (2H, m), 2.55 - 2.64 (4H, m), 3.39 - 3.47 (IH, m), 3.57 - 3.64 (IH, m), 4.24 (2H t), 4.62 - 4.72 (3H, m), 4.91 - 4.96 (IH, m), 6.96 (IH, t), 7.22 (IH t), 7.36 - 7.40 (IH, m), 7.45 (IH, t), 8.09 - 8.13 (2H, m), 8.32 (IH, d), 8.61 (IH, s), 9.51 (IH, d); m/z 543 (M+H)+.
Example 22: -f6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-ylloxy-5-[(3R)-l-ethyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-yl|oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide
Figure imgf000073_0002
From racemic 3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-(l-ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- yl)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide (197 mg, 0.38 mmol) (Example 10), 3-[6- (azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -y 1] oxy-5 - [(3R)- 1 -ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl] oxy-N-(5 - methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using a Merck 50mm 20μm Chiralcel OJ column eluting with methanol at a flow rate of 60 mL/min. 197 mg of racemic material was separated in 1 injection of 5 mL at 40 mg/ml in methanol to afford the product which eluted before its enantiomer to afford the product (55 mg, 28%). ^H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 1.18 (t, 3H), 2.13 - 2.26 (m, IH), 2.36 (quintet, 2H), 2.52 - 2.69 (m, 4H), 3.36 - 3.58 (m, 4H), 4.25 (t, 2H), 4.71 (t, 2H), 4.95 (t, IH), 6.98 (s, IH), 7.22 (s, IH), 7.39 (d, IH), 7.47 (s, IH), 8.12 (d, IH), 8.14 (s, IH), 8.33 (s, IH), 8.56 (s, IH), 9.53 (s, IH); m/z 517 (M+H)+.
Example 23: 3-f6-(Azetidine-l-carbonv0pyridin-3-ylloxy-5-r(3S)-l-ethyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide
Figure imgf000074_0001
From racemic 3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-(l-ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidm-3- yl)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide (197 mg, 0.38 mmol) (Example 10), 3-[6- (azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)- 1 -ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using a Merck 50mm 20 μm Chiralcel OJ column eluting with methanol at a flow rate of 60 mL/min. 197 mg of racemic material was separated in 1 injection of 5 mL at 40 mg/ml in methanol to afford the product which eluted after its enantiomer to afford the product (51 mg, 26%). ^H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 1.18 (t, 3H), 2.13 - 2.26 (m, IH), 2.36 (quintet, 2H), 2.52 - 2.69 (m, 4H), 3.36 - 3.58 (m, 4H), 4.25 (t, 2H), 4.71 (t, 2H), 4.95 (t, IH), 6.98 (s, IH), 7.22 (s, IH), 7.39 (d, IH), 7.47 (s, IH), 8.12 (d, IH), 8.14 (s, IH), 8.33 (s, IH), 8.56 (s, IH), 9.53 (s, IH); m/z 517 (M+H)+.
Example 24: N.N-Dimethyl-5-f3-r(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-5-r(5- methylpyrazin-l-vOcarbamoyllphenoxylpyrazine^-carboxamide
Figure imgf000075_0001
A mixture of 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (188 mg, 0.55 mmol), 5-(azetidin-l-ylcarbonyl)-2- chloropyrazine (CAS no. 915949-00-7) (712 mg, 3.6 mmol) and potassium carbonate (152 mg, 0.55 mmol) in acetonitrile (5 mL) was stirred at 120 0C for 2 hours. The solution was evaporated to dryness then diluted with ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with water (2 x 10 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 50-100% ethyl acetate in isohexane to afford the product (210 mg, 78%). 1H NMR δ(300 MHz, CDCL3) 2.15 - 2.31 (m, IH), 2.52 - 2.68 (m, IH), 2.56 (s, 3H), 2.95 (s, 3H), 3.17 (d, 6H), 3.35 - 3.59 (m, 2H), 4.95 (t, IH), 7.15 (s, IH), 7.37 (s, IH), 7.56 (s, IH), 8.14 (s, IH), 8.39 (s, IH), 8.52 (s, 2H), 9.54 (s, IH); m/z 492 (M+H)+.
Example 25: 3-f(2,2-Dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicvclof5.4.01undeca-7,9,ll-trien-9-vnoxyl-5- [(3S")-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(lH-pyrazol-3-yl)benzamide
Figure imgf000075_0002
The tert-butyl 3-[[3-[(2,2-dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicyclo[5.4.0Jundeca-7,9,l l-trien-9-yl)oxy]-5-
[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoyl]amino]pyrazole-l-carboxylate (412 mg,
0.67 mmol) (Intermediate 40) was dissolved in acetonitrile (5 mL) and heated in the microwave for 12 minutes at 150 0C. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to afford the product (348 mg, 100%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.10 - 2.24 (m, IH), 2.35 - 2.45 (m, 2H), 2.48 - 2.66 (m, IH), 2.92 (s, 3H), 3.29 - 3.53 (m, 4H), 4.22 (t, 2H), 4.89 (t, IH), 6.71 (s, IH), 6.77 (s, IH), 6.80 - 6.86 (m, 2H), 7.19 (s, IH), 7.44 (s, IH), 7.47 (s, IH), 7.89 (d, IH), 10.24 (s, IH); mlz 513 (M+H+)
Example 26: S-fl-Chloro^-fdimethylcarbamovDphenoxyl-S-ffSSVl-methyl^-oxo- Pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vDbenzamide
Figure imgf000076_0001
A mixture of 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-niethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (206 mg, 0.6 mmol), 3-chloro-4-fluoro-N,N-dimethyl- benzamide (CAS no. 871657-07-7) (192 mg, 0.9 mmol) and potassium carbonate (166 mg, 1.2 mmol) in N,N-dimethylacetamide (5 mL) was stirred at 16O0C for 6 hours. The solution was evaporated under reduced pressure, the residue dissolved in ethyl acetate (40 mL), washed with water (2 x 20 mL) and brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0-4% methanol in DCM to afford the product (98 mg, 31%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.10 - 2.27 (m, IH), 2.54 - 2.67 (m, IH), 2.55 (s, 3H), 2.93 (s, 3H), 2.98 - 3.19 (m, 6H), 3.34 - 3.57 (m, 2H), 4.92 (t, IH), 6.86 (s, IH), 7.06 (d, IH), 7.16 (s, IH), 7.33 (d, IH), 7.40 (s, IH), 7.57 (s, IH), 8.13 (s, IH), 8.53 (s, IH), 9.51 (s, IH); m/z 524 (M+H+).
Example 27 : 3-[(6,6-dioxo-2-oxa-6-λ6-thia-5-azabicvclo[5.4.01undeca-8α0.12-trien-10- vπoxyl-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vπbenzamide
Figure imgf000076_0002
A mixture of 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-memyl-2-oxo-pyiτolidin-3-yl]oxy-N~(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (206 mg, 0.6 mmol), 2,4-difluoro-N-(2- hydroxyethyl)benzenesulfonamide (CAS no. 915771-62-9) (213 mg, 0.9 mmol) and potassium carbonate (166 mg, 1.2 mmol) in N,N-dimethylacetamide (5 mL) was stirred at 160°C for 6 hrs. The solution was evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue dissolved in ethyl acetate (32 mL) and DCM (8 mL), washed with water (2 x 20 mL), brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0-4% methanol in DCM to give afford the product (19 mg, 6%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.12 - 2.26 (m, IH), 2.54 - 2.68 (m, IH), 2.55 (s, 3H), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.35 - 3.57 (m, 3H), 3.61 - 3.70 (m, 2H), 4.23 (t, 2H), 4.94 (t, IH), 5.04 (t, IH), 6.74 (s, IH), 6.79 (d, IH), 6.95 (s, IH), 7.22 (s, IH), 7.46 (s, IH), 7.77 (d, IH), 8.72 (s, IH), 9.48 (s, IH); mlz 540 (M+H+).
Example 28: 3-r(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methvIpyrazin-2-vπ-5-(6- methylsulfonylpyridin-3-vπoxy-benzamide
Figure imgf000077_0001
A mixture 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (305 mg, 0.6 mmol), 5-bromo-2-methylsulfonyl-pyridine (CAS no. 98626-95-0) (142 mg, 0.6 mmol), cesium carbonate (390 mg, 1.2 mmol) and tris(triphenylphosphine)copper bromide (CAS no. 15709-74-7) (112 mg, 0.12 mmol) in N9N- dimethylacetamide (5 mL) was stirred in the microwave at 1600C for 6 hours. N9N- Dimethylacetamide was removed by evaporation under reduced pressure. The residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate (30 mL) and water (50 mL). The organic phase was separated and the aqueous layer was acidified with hydrochloric acid (IN, 5 mL) and extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 50 mL). The combined organic extracts were washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0-5% methanol in DCM to afford the product (120 mg, 40%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.14 - 2.32 (m, IH), 2.52 - 2.69 (m, IH), 2.55 (s, 3H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.23 (s, 3H), 3.35 - 3.59 (m, 2H), 4.96 (t, IH), 7.05 (s, IH), 7.27 (s, IH), 7.48 (d, IH), 7.54 (s, IH), 8.07 (d, IH), 8.14 (s, IH), 8.49 (s, IH), 8.55 (s, IH), 9.51 (s, IH); mlz 498 (M+H+).
Example 29: N.N-dimethyl-5-r3-r(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrroUdin-3-ylloxy-5-r(5- methylpyrazin-2-vπcarbamovUphenoxylpyridine-2-carboxamide
Figure imgf000078_0001
A mixture of 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (206 mg, 0.6 mmol), 5-bromo-N,N-dimethyl-pyridine-2- carboxamide (CAS no. 845305-86-4) (165 mg, 0.72 mmol), cesium carbonate (587 mg,
1.8 mmol) and tris(triphenylphosphine)copper bromide (CAS no. 15709-74-7) (112 mg,
0.12 mmol) in N,N-dimethylacetamide (5 mL) was stirred at 1600C for 6 hours. The N,N- dimethylacetamide was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in water (20 mL) extracted with ethyl acetate (3 x 20 mL). The combined organic extracts were dried (MgSO4) and evaporated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0-5% methanol in DCM. The resulting compound was dissolved in ethyl acetate
(10 mL), washed with citric acid (IN, 10 mL), water (10 mL) and brine (10 mL), dried
(MgSO4) and the solvent evaporated to afford the product (67 mg, 23%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.14 - 2.26 (m, IH), 2.52 - 2.67 (m, IH), 2.55 (s, 3H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.15 (s,
6H), 3.34 - 3.57 (m, 2H), 4.94 (t, IH), 6.97 (s, IH), 7.23 (s, IH), 7.40 (d, IH), 7.46 (s, IH),
7.72 (s, IH), 8.14 (s, IH), 8.38 (s, IH), 8.58 (s, IH), 9.52 (s, IH); m/z 491 (M+H+).
Example 30: 3-r(9-methyl-10-oxo-7-oxa-9-azabicvclor4.4.01deca-2.4,ll-trien-4-yl)oxyl-5- f(3SVl-methyl-2-oχo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-N-(lH-pyrazol-3-yl)benzamide
Figure imgf000079_0001
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (0.88 niL, 0.66 mmol) was added to a solution of 3-[(9-methyl-10-oxo-7-oxa-9-azabicyclo[4.4.0]deca-2,4,ll-trien-4-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l- methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoic acid (Intermediate 43) (209 mg, 0.66 mmol) in DCM (10 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 30 minutes. tert-Butyl 3-aminopyrazole- 1-carboxylate (CAS no. 863504-94-1) (187 mg, 1.02 mmol) and pyridine (0.084 mL, 1.0 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred overnight. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with water (2 x 1OmL), saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (10 mL) and brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica, eluting with a gradient of 0 to 100% ethyl acetate in isohexane, followed by 5% methanol in DCM. The residue was dissolved in acetonitrile (5 mL) and heated in a microwave for 12 min at 15O0C. The resulting mixture was evaporated to dryness and the residue purified by flash chromatography on silica, eluting with 0-5% methanol in DCM to afford the product (50 mg, 16%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.05 - 2.21 (m, IH), 2.44 - 2.63 (m, IH), 2.68 - 2.85 (m, IH), 2.89 (s, 3H), 3.08 (s, 3H), 3.31 - 3.51 (m, 2H), 4.82 - 4.96 (m, IH), 5.15 (s, 2H), 6.51 (s, IH), 6.70 (d, IH), 6.78 (s, IH), 6.81 (s, IH), 7.22 (s, IH), 7.41 (s, IH), 7.43 (s, IH), 7.90 (d, IH), 10.29 (s, IH); mlz 478 (M+H+).
Example 31: N.N-dimethyl-5-r3-r(3SVl-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-vUoxy-5-r(3-methvi- l,2,4-thiadiazoL-5-yl)carbamoyllphenoxylpyrazine-2-carboxamide
Figure imgf000079_0002
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (0.142 mL, 1.07 mmol) was added to a solution of 3 - [5-(dimethylcarbamoyl)ρyrazin-2-yl] oxy-5 - [(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl] oxy- benzoic acid (Intermediate 45) (358 mg, 0.9 mmol) in DCM (7 niL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 30 minutes. 3 -Methyl- 1, 2, 4-thiadiazol-5 -amine (CAS no. 17467-35-5) (206 mg, 1.8 mmol) and pyridine (0.147 niL, 1.8 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred for 20 hours. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (15 mL) and DCM (15 mL), washed with water (10 mL) and filtered to give a solid which was washed with water and dried. The filtrate was washed with citric acid (IN, 10 mL), water (10 mL), saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (10 mL), brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated. The residue was combined with the solid isolated from the filtration and purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with a gradient of 0-3% methanol in DCM to afford the product (322 mg, 72%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 1.93 - 2.06 (m, IH), 2.45 (s, 3H), 2.55 - 2.66 (m, IH), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.03 (s, 6H), 3.19 - 3.53 (m, 2H), 5.14 (t, IH), 7.30 (s, IH), 7.63 (s, IH), 7.72 (s, IH), 8.43 (s, IH), 8.58 (s, IH), 11.9 - 12.8 (br s, IH); mlz 498 (M+H+).
Example 32: N.N-DimethvI-5-r3-rf3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-5-r(4-methyl- l,3-thiazol-2-vDcarbamoyl]phenoxylpyrazine-2-earboxamide
Figure imgf000080_0001
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (0.14 mL, 1.1 mmol) was added to a solution of 3 - [5 -(dimethylcarbamoyl)pyrazin-2-yl] oxy-5 - [(3S)-I -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl] oxy- benzoic acid (Intermediate 45) (358 mg, 0.9 mmol) in DCM (7 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 30 minutes. 4-Methyl-l,3-thiazol-2-amine (CAS no. 1603-91-4) (206 mg, 1.8 mmol) and pyridine (0.15 mL, 1.8 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred for 20 hours. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with water (2 x 10 mL) and brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with a gradient of 0 to 5% methanol in DCM to afford the product (200 mg, 45%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.09 - 2.22 (m, IH), 2.25 (s, 3H), 2.50 - 2.65 (m, IH), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.18 (d, 6H), 3.34 - 3.55 (m, 2H), 4.86 (t, IH), 6.56 (s, IH), 7.16 (s, IH), 7.37 (s, IH), 7.54 (s, IH), 8.37 (s, IH), 8.51 (s, IH), 10.0 - 11.0 (br s, IH); mlz 497 (M+H+).
Intermediate 1; S-fά-fAzetidine-l-carbonvDpyridin-S-ylloxy-S-hydroxy-N-CS- methvipyrazin-2-vDbenzamide
Figure imgf000081_0001
3 - [6-(Azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-N-(5 -methy lpyrazin-2-yl)-5 -phenylmethoxy- benzamide (Intermediate 2) (3.9 g, 7.9 mmol) was dissolved in ethyl acetate (200 mL) and ethanol (200 mL). 10% Palladium on carbon (390 mg, cat.) was added and the mixture stirred under an atmosphere of hydrogen for 16 hours. Methanol (150 mL) was added and the suspension was filtered. The filtrate was evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was washed firstly with methanol (150 mL), ethyl acetate (150 mL) and DMA (10 mL) and secondly with DMF (50 mL). The combined filtrates were evaporated under reduced pressure to afford the product (3.17 g, 99%). 1H NMR δ (400 MHz, DMSO) 11.02 (s, IH), 10.35 (s, IH), 9.26 (s, IH), 8.47 (s, IH), 8.40 (s, IH), 8.05 (d, IH), 7.62 (d, IH), 7.34 (s, IH), 7.31 (s, IH), 6.81 (s, IH), 4.64 (t, 2H), 4.13 (t, 2H), 2.53 (s, 3H), 2.33 (quintet, 2H); w/z 406 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 2: 3-f6-(azetidine-l-carbonvπpyridin-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)-5- phenylmethoxy-benzamide
Figure imgf000081_0002
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (2.4 niL, 18 mmol) was added to a solution of 3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-phenylmethoxy-benzoic acid (Intermediate 3) (6.19 g, 15 mmol) in DCM (100 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 30 minutes. Further l-chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (0.24 mL, 1.8 mmol) was added and stirring continued for 20 minutes. 5-Methylpyrazin-2-amine (CAS no. 5521-58-4) (3.34g, 31 mmol) and pyridine (2.5 mL, 31 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred for a further 16 hours. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (350 mL), washed with water (2x100 mL) and brine (100 mL), dried (MgSO4), and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography, eluting with a gradient of 50-75% ethyl acetate in isohexane, to afford the product (4.01 g, 53%). 1H NMR δ (400 MHz, CDCl3) 2.28 (quintet, 2H), 2.49 (s, 3H), 4.18 (t, 2H), 4.63 (t, 2H), 5.05 (s, 2H), 6.78 (s, IH), 7.10 (s, IH), 7.25 - 7.37 (m, 7H), 8.04 (d, IH), 8.07 (s, IH), 8.25 (s, 2H), 9.46 (s, IH); m/z 496 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 3: S-fβ-fAzetidine-l-carbonvOpyridin-S-ylloxy-S-phenylmethoxy-benzoic acid
Figure imgf000082_0001
A mixture of methyl 3-hydroxy-5-phenylmethoxy-benzoate (CAS no. 54915-31-0) (5.16 g, 20 mmol), azetidin-l-yl-(5-bromopyridin-2-yl)methanone (CAS no. 845306-16-3, Intermediate 34) (5.3 g, 22 mmol), caesium carbonate (19.6 g, 60 mmol) and tris(triphenylphosphine)copper bromide (CAS no. 15709-74-7) (3.73 g, 4 mmol) in DMA (100 mL) was stirred at 16O0C for 6 hours. The DMA was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in water (200 mL), washed with ethyl acetate (3x50 mL), acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid and extracted with ethyl acetate (3χ 100 mL): The organic layer washed with water (2x20 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and the solvent removed under reduced pressure to afford the product (6.18 g, 76%). 1H NMR δ (400 MHz, CDCl3) 2.29 (s, 2H), 4.20 (s, 2H), 4.64 (s, 2H), 5.04 (s, 2H), 6.83 (s, IH), 7.22 - 7.44 (m, 7H), 7.49 (s, IH), 7.79 - 8.63 (m, 2H); m/z 405 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 4: 3-Bromo-l-methyl-pyrrolidin-2-one
Figure imgf000083_0001
Sodium hydride (60%, 1.2 g, mmol) was added portionwise to a solution of 2,4-dibromo-N- methyl-butanamide (7.8 g, 30 mmol) (Intermediate 5, CAS no. 33693-57-1) in THF (25 mL) under argon at 10-15 0C. The mixture was added slowly to an ice- water mixture and extracted with DCM. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous layer re-extracted with DCM (2x10 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated to give a brown oil which was triturated with hexane and purified by column chromatography on silica eluting with 0-20% ethylacetate in DCM to afford the product (4.3 g, 81%). 1H NMR δ (400 MHz, CDCl3) 2.22 - 2.30 (m, IH), 2.54 (sextet, IH), 2.84 (s, 3H), 3.22 - 3.29 (dt, IH), 3.46 - 3.54 (dt, IH), 4.34 (d, IH); m/z 178 (M+H)+
Intermediate 5: 2,4-dibromo-N-methyl-butanamide
Figure imgf000083_0002
2,4-Dibromobutanoyl chloride (CAS no. 82820-87-9) (16.9 g, 64 mmol) in DCM (20 mL) was added dropwise to a solution of methylamine (20 mL) in water (30 mL) and DCM (30 mL) at 10-15°C, then warmed to 3O0C and stirred for 30 minutes. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous layer re-extracted with DCM (2x10 mL), the combined organic layers were washed with brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated to afford the product (16.3 g, 98%). 1H NMR δ (400 MHz, CDCl3) 2.35 - 2.45 (m, IH), 2.57 - 2.67 (m, IH), 2.81 (d, 3H), 3.44 - 3.54 (m, 2H), 4.46 (q, IH), 6.34 (s, IH).
Intermediate 6; 345-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyrazin-2-ylloxy-5-[(3Syi-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-benzoic acid
Figure imgf000084_0001
Methyl 3-[5-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyrazin-2-yl]oxy-5-[(3 S)- 1 ~methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 7) (304 mg, 0.71 mmol) was dissolved in THF (6 mL) and methanol (2 mL); IN lithium hydroxide solution (0.85 mL) was added followed by water (8 mL), and the resultant solution was stirred for 1 hr at room temperature. The majority of the organic solvent was removed by distillation, the remaining aqueous solution was filtered and acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid and extracted with 1 : 1 ethyl acetate: DCM (2x40 mL). The combined organic extracts were washed with water (10 mL) and brine (20 mL) and dried (MgSO4) to afford the product (265 mg, 96%). 1R NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.12 - 2.27 (m, IH), 2.38 (quintet, 2H), 2.52 - 2.67 (m, IH), 2.95 (s, 3H), 3.36 - 3.57 (m, 2H), 4.27 (t, 2H), 4.68 (t, 2H), 4.97 (t, IH), 7.10 (s, IH), 7.45 (s, IH), 7.62 (s, IH), 8.31 (s, IH), 8.84 (s, IH); m/z 413 (M+H)+
Intermediate 7: Methyl 3-[5-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyrazin-2-ylloxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2- oxo-PyrroIidin-3-vIloxy-benzoate
Figure imgf000084_0002
A mixture of methyl 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 8) (265 mg, 1.0 mmol), azetidin-l-yl-(5-chloropyrazin-2-yl)methanone (Intermediate 32) (198 mg, 1.0 mmol) and polymer supported-carbonate (690 mg, 2.0 mmol) in DMA (5 mL) was stirred at 100°C for 1 hr. The mixture was filtered and the DMA was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (50 mL), washed with saturated sodium bicarbonate (10 mL), water (20 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by chromatography on silica eluting with 20-100% ethyl acetate in isohexane then 10% Methanol in DCM to give afford the product (304 mg, 71%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) , 2.13 - 2.27 (m, IH), 2.31 - 2.44 (m, 2H), 2.53 - 2.66 (m, IH), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.35 - 3.58 (m, 2H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 4.26 (t, 2H), 4.68 (t, 2H), 4.93 (t, IH), 7.14 (s, IH), 7.46 (s, IH), 7.60 (s, IH), 8.31 (s, IH), 8.84 (s, IH); m/z All (M+H)+
Intermediate 8: Methyl 3-hvdroxy-5-l(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-benzoate
Figure imgf000085_0001
A solution of methyl 3-[(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-phenylmethoxy-benzoate (Intermediate 9) (1.42 g, 4.0 mmol) was added to a suspension of 10% palladium on carbon (140 mg, catalytic) in THF (40 mL) and methanol (40 mL). The mixture was stirred under an atmosphere of hydrogen for 16 hours. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate evaporated under reduced pressure to give the product (1.06 g, 100%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) . 2.06 - 2.20 (m, IH), 2.56 - 2.68 (m, IH), 2.97 (s, 3H), 3.37 - 3.55 (m, 2H), 3.86 (s, 3H), 4.93 (t, IH), 6.81 (s, IH), 7.04 (s, IH), 7.12 (s, IH), 7.66 (s, IH); m/z 266 (M+H)+
Intermediate 9: Methyl 3-K3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-5-phenylmethoxy- benzoate
Figure imgf000085_0002
Methyl 3-hydroxy-5-phenylmethoxy-benzoate (CAS no. 54915-31-0) (10.3 g, 40 mmol) and
3-bromo-l-methyl-pyrrolidin-2-one (Intermediate 4) (8.54 g, 48 mmol) were dissolved in DMF, treated with potassium carbonate (12.1 g, 88 mmol) and stirred at room temperature for 16 hours and then at 5O0C for 3 hours. The DMF was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue partitioned between ethyl acetate (100 mL) and water (30 mL). The organic layer was separated, washed with brine (30 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0-100% ethyl acetate in hexane to give the racemic product (8.7 g). The desired product was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using Merck 50mm 20 μm Chiralpak AS - No ASVOOSC JGOOl and ASVOOOSC BD004 columns in series, eluting with 30% ethylacetate in isohexane at a flow rate of 60 mL / min, using 9 separate injections of 70 mL of a 14 mg/ml solution of the racemate in ethanol (32 mL) and isohexane (38 mL) to afford the product (3.6 g, 41%) which eluted before its enantiomer. 1U NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.06 - 2.20 (m, IH), 2.51 - 2.63 (m, IH), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.31 - 3.54 (m, 2H), 3.89 (s, 3H), 4.87 (t, IH), 5.08 (s, 2H), 6.90 (t, IH), 7.27 - 7.46 (m, 7H).
Intermediate 10: 3-15-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyrazin-2-vH oxy-5-f(3R)-l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-benzoic acid
Figure imgf000086_0001
Methyl 3 - [5 -(azetidine- 1 -carbony l)pyrazin-2-yl] oxy-5 - [(3R)-I -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 - yljoxy-benzoate (Intermediate 11) (292 mg, 0.68 mmol) was dissolved in THF (6 mL) and methanol (2 mL) and IN Lithium hydroxide (0.85 mL) was added, followed by water (8 mL). The resultant solution was stirred for 1 hr at room temperature. The majority of the organic solvent was removed by distillation, the remaining aqueous solution was filtered and acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid and extracted with 1:1 ethyl acetate: DCM (2x40 mL), the organics were washed with water (10 mL) and brine (20 mL) and dried (MgSO4) to afford the product (280 mg, 100%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.12 - 2.27 (m, IH), 2.38 (quintet, 2H), 2.52 - 2.67 (m, IH), 2.95 (s, 3H), 3.36 - 3.57 (m, 2H), 4.27 (t, 2H), 4.68 (t, 2H), 4.97 (t, IH), 7.10 (s, IH), 7.45 (s, IH), 7.62 (s, IH), 8.31 (s, IH), 8.84 (s, IH); m/z 413 (M+H)+
Intermediate 11: Methyl 3-[5-(azetidine-l-earbonvDpyrazin-2-vIloxy-5-f(3RVl-methyl~ 2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-vUoxy-benzoate
Figure imgf000087_0001
A mixture of methyl 3-hydroxy-5-[(3R)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 12) (265 mg, 1 mmol), azetidin-l-yl-(5-chloropyrazin-2-yl)methanone (Intermediate 32) (298 mg, 1.5 mmol) and polymer supported-carbonate (860 mg, 2.5 mmol) in DMA (5 niL) was stirred at 1000C for 2 hours. The mixture was filtered and the DMA was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 20-100% ethyl acetate in isohexane then 10% methanol in DCM to afford the product (292 mg, 68%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.13 - 2.27 (m, IH), 2.31 - 2.44 (m, 2H), 2.53 - 2.66 (m, IH), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.35 - 3.58 (m, 2H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 4.26 (t, 2H), 4.68 (t, 2H), 4.93 (t, IH), 7.14 (s, IH), 7.46 (s, IH), 7.60 (s, IH), 8.31 (s, IH), 8.84 (s, IH); m/z 427 (M+H)+
Intermediate 12: Methyl 3-hvdroxy-5-[(3R)-l-methvI-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-vIloxy- benzoate
Figure imgf000087_0002
A solution of methyl 3-[(3R)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-phenylmethoxy-benzoate (Intermediate 13) (1.42 g, 4.0 mmol) was added to a suspension of 10% palladium on carbon (140 mg, catalytic) in THF (40 mL) and methanol (40 mL). The mixture was stirred under an atmosphere of hydrogen for 16 hours. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate evaporated under reduced pressure to give the product (1.04 g, 98%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.06 - 2.20 (m, IH), 2.56 - 2.68 (m, IH), 2.97 (s, 3H), 3.37 - 3.55 (m, 2H), 3.86 (s, 3H), 4.93 (t, IH), 6.81 (s, IH), 7.04 (s, IH), 7.12 (s, IH), 7.66 (s, IH); m/z 266 (M+H)+
Intermediate 13: Methyl 3-f(3R)-l-methyl-2-oxo-PyrroLidin-3-vIloxy-5-phenylmethoxy- benzoate
Figure imgf000088_0001
Methyl 3-hydroxy-5-phenylmethoxy-benzoate (CAS no. 54915-31-0) (10.3 g, 40 mmol) and 3-bromo-l-methyl-pyrrolidin-2-one (Intermediate 4) (8.54 g, 48 mmol) were dissolved in DMF and treated with potassium carbonate (12.1 g, 88 mmol) and stirred at room temperature for 16 hours and then at 500C for 3 hours. The DMF was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue partitioned between ethyl acetate (100 mL) and water (30 mL). The organic layer was separated, washed with brine (30 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0- 100% ethyl acetate in hexane to give the racemic product (8.7 g). The desired product was separated from its enantiomer by chiral HPLC using Merck 50mm 20μm Chiralpak AS - No ASVOOSC JGOOl and ASVOOOSC BD004 columns in series, eluting with 30% ethylacetate in isohexane at a flow rate of 60 mL / min, using 9 separate injections of 70 mL of a 14 mg/ml solution of the racemate in Ethanol (32 mL) and isohexane (38 mL) to afford the product (3.6 g, 41%) which eluted after its enantiomer. 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.06 - 2.20 (m, IH), 2.51 - 2.63 (m, IH), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.31 - 3.54 (m, 2H), 3.89 (s, 3H), 4.87 (t, IH), 5.08 (s, 2H), 6.90 (t, IH), 7.27 - 7.46 (m, 7H).
Intermediate 14: tert-Butyl 3-[[3-[4-(azetidine-l-carbonvDphenoxyl-5-r(3SVl-methyl-2- oxo-pyrroϋdin-3-yll oxy-benzoyll aminolpyrazole-1-carboxylate
Figure imgf000088_0002
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (0.12 mL, 0.87 mmol) was added to a solution of 3 - [4-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)phenoxy] -5-[(3S)-I -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl] oxy-benzoic acid (Intermediate 15) (298 mg, 0.73 mmol) in DCM (5 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 30 minutes. tert-Butyl 3-aminopyrazole-l-carboxylate (CAS no. 863504-94- 1) (268 mg, 1.46 mmol) and pyridine (0.119 mL, 1.46 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred for 16 hours. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with water (2x1 OmI) and brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica, eluting with a gradient of 0-100% ethyl acetate in isohexane, followed by 5% methanol in DCM to afford the product (388 mg, 93%). m/z 51 A (M-H)"
Intermediate 15: 3- f 4-(Azetidine-l-car bonvDphenoxyl -5- [(3 SV l-methyl-2-oxo- Pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-benzoic acid
Figure imgf000089_0001
Methyl 3-[4-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)phenoxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy- benzoate (Intermediate 16) (309 mg, 0.73 mmol) was dissolved in THF (6 mL) and methanol (2 mL) and IN lithium hydroxide (0.88 mL) was added followed by water (8 mL). The resultant solution was stirred for 1 hr at room temperature. The majority of the organic solvent was removed by distillation under reduced pressure. The remaining aqueous solution was filtered and acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid and extracted with ethyl acetate (2x40 mL), the combined organics were washed with water (10 mL) and brine (20 mL) and dried (MgSO4) to afford the product (298 mg, 100%). m/z 411 (M+H)+
Intermediate 16: Methyl 3-[4-fazetidine-l-carbonyl)phenoxyl-5-f(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-vU oxy-benzoate
Figure imgf000089_0002
Methyl 3-[4-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)-2-chloro-phenoxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 17) (372 mg, 0.81 mmol) was added to a suspension of 10% palladium on carbon (37 mg, catalytic) in THF (10 mL) and ethanol (10 mL) and the resulting mixture was stirred under an atmosphere of hydrogen for 16 hours. The suspension was filtered and the filtrate evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with water(10 mL) and brine(10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure to afford the product (309 mg, 90%). 1HNMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.10 - 2.23 (m, IH), 2.36 (quintet, 2H), 2.52 - 2.65 (m, IH), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.32 - 3.54 (m, 2H), 3.89 (s, 3H), 4.18 - 4.39 (m, 4H), 4.90 (t, IH), 6.94 (s, IH), 7.01 (d, 2H), 7.32 (s, IH), 7.48 (s, IH), 7.64 (d, 2H); m/z 425 (M+H)+
Intermediate 17: Methyl 3-f4-(azetidine-l-carbonvO-2-chloro-phenoxyl-5-r(3S)-l- methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-benzoate
Figure imgf000090_0001
A mixture of methyl 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoate
(Intermediate 8) (265 mg, 1 mmol), azetidin-l-yl-(3-chloro-4-fluoro-phenyl)methanone (CAS no. 863454-79-9) (320 mg, 1.5 mmol) and potassium carbonate (276 mg, 2.0 mmol) in DMA (10 mL) was stirred at 12O0C for 16 hours. The solution was evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (50 mL), washed with water (3x20 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The combined aqueous extracts were acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid, extracted with a mixture of ethyl acetate and DCM (1:1, 3x20 mL), washed with brine, dried (MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue from this was dissolved in THF (2 mL) and methanol (1 mL) and treated with 2M (trimethylsilyl)diazomethane (0.240 mL, 0.48 mmol) and stirred for 30 minutes. The solution was treated with acetic acid (1 drop), evaporated under reduced pressure. This residue was combined with that from the initial ethyl acetate extraction and purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 20-100% ethyl acetate in isohexane to afford the product (380 mg, 83%). m/z 459 (M+H)+
Intermediate 18; 3-Hvdroxy-5-r(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-vUoxy-N-(5- methyIpyrazin-2-vDbenzamide
Figure imgf000091_0001
A solution of 3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)-5- phenylmethoxy-benzamide (Intermediate 19) (449 mg, 1.04 mmol) in THF (10 mL) and methanol (10 mL) containing 10% palladium on carbon (catalytic) was stirred under an atmosphere of hydrogen for 16 hours. The palladium on carbon was removed by filtration and the filtrate evaporated under reduced pressure to afford product (390 mg, 100%). 1HNMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.07 - 2.22 (m, IH), 2.54 (s, 3H), 2.57 - 2.70 (m, IH), 2.97 (s, 3H), 3.38 - 3.58 (m, 3H), 4.99 (t, IH), 6.71 (s, IH), 6.87 (s, IH), 6.97 (s, IH), 8.15 (s, IH), 8.66 (s, IH), 9.49 (s, IH); m/z 343 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 19 : 3- li3S)-l-Methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yll oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vO- 5-phenylmethoxy-benzamide
Figure imgf000091_0002
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (0.979 mL, 7.4 mmol) was added to a solution of 3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-phenylmethoxy-benzoic acid (Intermediate 20) (2.1g, 6.2 mmol) in DCM (50 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 50 minutes. 5- Methylpyrazin-2-amine (CAS no. 5521-58-4) (1.35 g, 12.4 mmol) and pyridine (1.0 mL, 12 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred for a further 3 hours. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue taken up in ethyl acetate (50 mL), washed with water (2x10 mL), brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and filtered. Evaporation under reduced pressure gave crude product which was purified by flash chromatography on silica, eluting with a gradient of 0-100% ethyl acetate in isohexane. This crystallised to afford the product (449 mg, 17%). To the filtrate was added saturated sodium bicarbonate (20 niL) and the mixture extracted with 2: 1 ethyl acetate:DCM (3x45 mL), the organics were washed with brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated under reduced pressure to give further product (937 mg, 35%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.09 - 2.24 (m, IH), 2.53 - 2.66 (m, 4H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.33 - 3.57 (m, 2H), 4.89 (t, IH), 5.10 (s, 2H), 6.91 (s, IH), 7.15 - 7.20 (m, 2H), 7.30 - 7.48 (m, 5H), 8.13 (s, IH), 8.40 (s, IH), 9.54 (s, IH); m/z 433 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 20: 3-[(3S)-l-Methyl-2-oxo-pyrroIidin-3-ylloxy-5-phenylmethoxy-benzoic acid
Figure imgf000092_0001
Methyl 3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-phenylmethoxy-benzoate (Intermediate 9) (2.4 g, 6.8 mmol) was dissolved in THF (45 mL), methanol (15 mL) and IN lithiumhydroxide (8.1 mL). Water (60 mL) was added dropwise until the solution went cloudy and the resultant solution was stirred for 3 hours at room temperature. The organics were removed by evaporation under reduced pressure, the aqueous solution was filtered, acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid, extracted with ethyl acetate (3x20 mL), washed with water (1OmL), brine (1OmL) and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure to give product (2.106g, 92%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.07 - 2.21 (m, IH), 2.51 - 2.65 (m, IH), 2.96 (s, 3H), 3.32 - 3.55 (m, 2H), 4.92 (t, IH), 5.06 (s, 2H), 6.88 (s, IH), 7.28 - 7.46 (m, 7H); m/z 340 (M-H)".
Intermediate 21 : Azetidin-l-yl-(5,6-dichloropyridin-3-vDmethanone
Figure imgf000093_0001
5,6-Dichloropyridine-3-carboxylic acid (CAS no. 41667-95-2) (32 g, 0.17 mol) was suspended in DCM (500 mL) and IM HCl in ether (0.17 L, 0.17 mol) added. Oxalyl chloride (17 mL, 0.20 mol) and then DMF (2 drops) were added and stirred at room temperature for 16 hours. The reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure, azeotroped with toluene and re-dissolved into DCM (250 mL). Azetidine hydrochloride (17.5 g, 0.18 mol) was added, followed by triethylamine (51 mL, 0.37 mol) and the reaction stirred at room temperature for 2 hours. The reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure then water (500 mL) and ethyl acetate (500 mL) were added. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous phase was re-extracted with ethyl acetate (5x15OmL). The combined organics were washed with citric acid (250 mL), saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (250 mL), brine (250 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated under reduced pressure to give a solid which was recrystallised in ethyl acetate and dried under reduced pressure to give the product (18.2g, 47%). 1H NMR δ (400 MHz, CDCl3) 2.34 (quintet, 2H), 4.20 (s, 2H), 4.27 (s, 2H), 8.02 (d, IH), 8.44 (d, IH); m/z 231 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 22: 3-f4-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)-2-chloro-phenoxy1-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidm-3-ylloxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-vObenzamide
Figure imgf000093_0002
A mixture of 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)benzamide (Intermediate 18) (136 mg, 0.4 mmol), azetidin-l-yl-(3-chloro-4-fluoro- phenyl)methanone (CAS no. 863454-79-9) (128 mg, 0.6 mmol) and potassium carbonate (111 mg, 0.8 mmol) in DMA (5 mL) was stirred at 1200C for 16 hours. The solution was evaporated under reduced pressure, then the residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate (40 mL), washed with water (2x20 mL) and brine (10 mL), then dried (MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by chromatography on silica eluting with 0-4% methanol/DCM to afford the product (120 mg, 56%). m/z 536 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 23: 9-Fluoro-6-oxa-2λ6-thiabicyclof5.4.01undeca-8,10,12-triene 2,2-dioxide
Figure imgf000094_0001
m-Chloroperbenzoic acid (77%, 17.0 g, 69 mmol) was added to a mixture of 9-fluoro-6-oxa- 2-thiabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8,10,12-triene (Intermediate 24) (5.1 g, 28 mmol)) and MgSO4 (excess) in DCM and stirred at ambient temperature for 24 hours. Water (300 mL) was added and the mixture was extracted with dichloromethane (2x300 mL). The combined organic extracts were washed with 2N sodium hydroxide solution (200 mL) and brine (200 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography, eluting with 0-80% ethyl acetate in isohexane to afford the product (5.3 g, 88%). 1H NMR δ (400MHz, CDCl3): 2.41 - 2.46 (m, 2H), 3.34 - 3.37 (m, 2H), 4.26 - 4.29 (m, 2H), 6.88 - 6.91 (m, IH), 6.95 - 7.00 (m, IH), 7.96 - 8.00 (m, IH).
Intermediate 24: 9-Fluoro-6-oxa-2-thiabicyclof5.4.01undeca-8,1042-triene
Figure imgf000094_0002
Sodium hydride (60%, 3.4, 85 mmol) was added to a solution of 3-(2,4- difluorophenyl)surfanylpropan-l-ol (Intermediate 25) (7.9 g, 37 mmol) in THF (400 mL) and the mixture stirred at ambient temperature for 24 hours and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. Ice / water (200 mL) was added and extracted into ethyl acetate (2x500 mL), the combined organics were washed with brine (40 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica, eluting with 0-10% ethyl acetate in isohexane to afford the product (5.1 g, 75%). 1H NMR δ (400 MHZ, CDCl3): 2.22 - 2.29 (m, 2H), 2.86 - 2.91 (m, 2H), 4.20 - 4.23 (m, 2H), 6.64 - 6.77 (m, 2H), 7.30 - 7.36 (m, IH); m/z 185 (M+H)+. Intermediate 25: 3-(2,4-difluorophenv0sulfanylpropan-l-ol
Figure imgf000095_0001
IM Hydrochloric acid (170 mL) was added to a solution of 2-[3-(2,4- difluorophenyl)sulfanylpropoxy]oxane (Intermediate 26) (10.8 g, 37 mmol) in methanol (170 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 40 minutes. The methanol was removed under reduced pressure and the remaining aqueous phase taken to pH 6. The solution was extracted with ethyl acetate (3x50 mL) and the combined organics washed with brine (50 mL), dried (MgSO4) and the solvent removed under reduced pressure to afford the product (7.5 g, 99%). 1H NMR δ (400MHz, CDCl3): 1.38 (t, IH), 1.83 (quintet, 2H), 2.97 (t, 2H), 3.77 (q, 2H), 6.81 - 6.87 (m, 2H), 7.38 - 7.45 (m, IH).
Intermediate 26: 2-[3-(2,4-difluorophenyl)sulfanylpropoxyloxane
Figure imgf000095_0002
Sodium hydride (60%) (1.72 g, 44.8 mmol) was added to a solution of 2,4- difluorobenzenethiol (CAS no. 1996-44-7) (4.6 mL, 40 mmol) in THF (150 mL) at O0C, under argon. The mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature and 2-(3-bromopropoxy)oxane (CAS no. 33821-94-2) (7.6 mL, 45 mmol) was added. The reaction was stirred at ambient temperature for 16 hours. The mixture was poured into ice / water (250 mL) and extracted with ethyl acetate (250 mL). The organic extract was washed with brine, dried (MgSO4) and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography, eluting with 0-10% ethyl acetate in isohexane afford the product (10.8 g, 84%). 1H NMR δ (400 MHZ, CDCl3): 1.49 - 1.61 (m, 4H), 1.65 - 1.73 (m, IH), 1.75 - 1.90 (m, 3H), 2.96 (t, 2H), 3.46 - 3.52 (m, 2H), 3.79 - 3.87 (m, 2H), 4.55 - 4.56 (m, IH), 6.80 - 6.86 (m, 2H), 7.38 - 7.44 (m, IH).
Intermediate 27: Ethyl 2-f3-f6-(azetidine-l-carbonvI)pyridin-3-ylloxy-5-f(5- methvIpyrazin-2-vl)carbamovllphenoxvl-4-methvlsulfonyloxv-butanoate
Figure imgf000096_0001
Methanesulfonyl chloride (13 μL, 0.16 mmol) and triethylamine (34 μL, 0.24 mmol) were added to a solution of ethyl 2-[3-[6-(azetidme-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]-4-hydroxy-butanoate (Intermediate 28) (65 mg, 0.12 mmol) in DCM (5 niL) at 0°C under nitrogen. The reaction was allowed to warm to RT and stirred for 2 hours. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue partitioned between ethyl acetate (10 mL) and brine (10 mL). The organic layer was separated and the aqueous layer re-extracted with ethyl acetate (10 mL). The combined organics were dried (MgSO4), concentrated under reduced pressure and the residue purified by column chromatography on silica eluting with 0-10% methanol/DCM to give product (29 mg, 42%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 1.23 - 1.30 (3H, m), 2.33 - 2.46 (4H, m), 2.56 (3H, s), 3.03 (3H, s), 4.22 - 4.29 (4H, m), 4.44 - 4.49 (2H, m), 4.71 (2H t), 4.87 - 4.91 (IH, m), 6.81 (IH t), 7.21 (IH t), 7.29 (IH t), 7.38 - 7.41 (IH, m), 8.13 (2H d), 8.34 (IH d), 8.42 (IH, s), 9.51 (IH, s); m/z 615 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 28: Ethyl 2-[3-f6-(azetidine-l-carbonvDpyridin-3-vHoxy-5-[(5- methylpyrazin-2-vDcarbamovH phenoxyl -4-hvdroxy-butanoate
Figure imgf000096_0002
Potassium carbonate (113 mg, 0.82 mmol) was added to a solution of 3-[6-(azetidine-l- carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)-5-(2-oxooxolan-3-yl)oxy-benzamide (Intermediate 29) (800 mg, 1.6 mmol) in ethanol (80 niL) at O0C under nitrogen. The reaction was allowed to warm to RT and stirred for 4 hours. The reaction mixture was filtered through silica, washing well with ethyl acetate, and concentrated to afford crude product which was used directly in the next stage without further purification.
Intermediate 29: 3- [6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yll oxy-N-(5-methyIpyrazin-2-vD- 5-(2-oxooxolan-3-yl)oxy-benzamide
Figure imgf000097_0001
3 - [6-(Azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 -hydroxy-N-(5 -methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide (Intermediate 1) (203 mg, 0.5 mmol), 3-hydroxyoxolan-2-one (CAS no. 19444-84-9) (0.078 mL, 1 mmol) and triphenyl phosphine (262 mg, 1 mmol) in anhydrous THF (10 niL) under argon at O0C was treated dropwise with DIAD (0.20 mL, 1 mmol). The mixture allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 16 hours. The solvent was removed by evaporation under reduced pressure and the residue was purified by chromatography on silica eluting with 0-4% methanol:DCM to give product (212 mg 86%). 1H NMR δ (400 MHz, CDCl3) 2.29 (quintet, 2H), 2.40 - 2.48 (m, IH), 2.50 (s, 3H), 2.69 - 2.78 (m, IH), 4.18 (t, 2H), 4.33 (q, IH), 4.49 (t, IH), 4.64 (t, 2H), 4.99 (t, IH), 6.89 (s, IH), 7.18 (s, IH), 7.33 (d, IH), 7.36 (s, IH), 8.06 (d, IH), 8.08 (s, IH), 8.28 (s, IH), 8.41 (s, IH), 9.46 (s, 1H); /M/Z 490 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 30: S-lό-fAzetidine-l-carbonvOpyridin-S-ylloxy-S-KSSVl-methyl^-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-yiloxy-benzoic acid
Figure imgf000097_0002
Methyl 3 - [6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 - [(3S)-I -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 - yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 31) (439 nig, 1.0 mniol) was dissolved in THF (6 niL) and methanol, (2 niL) and IN lithium hydroxide (1.24 niL) was added. Water (8 mL) was then added dropwise and the resultant solution stirred for 1 hour at room temperature. The majority of the organic solvents were removed by distillation under reduced pressure. The aqueous residue was acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid and extracted with ethyl acetate (2x40 mL). The combined organic extracts were washed with water (10 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure to afford the product (406 mg, 96%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.10 - 2.26 (m, 2H), 2.29 - 2.43 (m, 2H), 2.55 - 2.69 (m, IH), 2.96 (s, 3H), 3.36 - 3.59 (m, 4H), 4.26 (t, 2H), 4.71 (t, 2H), 4.98 (t, IH), 6.95 (s, IH), 7.29 (s, 3H), 7.34 (d, 2H), 7.55 (s, IH), 8.09 (d, IH), 8.30 (s, IH); m/z 411 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 31: Methyl 3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yIloxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2- oxo-Pyrrolidin-3-vUoxy-benzoate
Figure imgf000098_0001
A mixture of methyl 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoate
(Intermediate 8) (530 mg, 2 mmol), azetidin-l-yl-(5-bromopyridin-2-yl)methanone (CAS no. 845306-16-3) (531 mg, 2.2 mmol), caesium carbonate (1.956 g, 6 mmol) and tris(triphenylphosphine)copper bromide (CAS no. 15709-74-7) (373 mg, 0.4 mmol) in DMA (5 mL) was stirred at 16O0C for 6 hours. The DMA was evaporated under reduced pressure and the residue was dissolved in water (520 mL) washed with ethyl acetate (3x20 mL). The aqueous fraction was acidified with 2N hydrochloric acid and extracted with ethyl acetate (3x100 mL), the combined organic layers were washed with water (2x20 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in THF (6 mL) and methanol (3 mL) and was treated dropwise with 2M
(trimethylsilyl)diazomethane in hexane (1.1 mL). The reaction was stirred for 30min then treated with 1 drop of acetic acid, stirred for another 15 minutes and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by chromatography eluting with 0-100% ethyl acetate/ hexane to give afford the product (439 mg, 52%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.10 - 2.24 (m, IH), 2.35 (quintet, 2H), 2.52 - 2.67 (m, IH), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.34 - 3.56 (m, 2H), 3.89 (s, 3H), 4.25 (t, 2H), 4.70 (t, 2H), 4.91 (t, IH), 6.99 (s, IH), 7.32 (s, IH), 7.35 (d, IH), 7.53 (s, IH), 8.10 (d, IH), 8.31 (s, IH); m/z 426 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 32: Azetidin-l-yl-(5-chloropyrazin-2-vDmethanone
Figure imgf000099_0001
Oxalyl chloride (1.55 mL, 17.5 mmol), followed by DMF (2 drops), was added to a mixture of 5-chloropyrazine-2-carboxylic acid (CAS no. 36070-80-1, Intermediate 33) (2.31 g, 14.6 mmol) in DCM (40 mL). The reaction was stirred at RT for 2 hours after which time the volatiles were removed under reduced pressure. The residue was taken up DCM (40 mL) and azetidine (1.08 mL, 16.03 mmol) and triethylamine (4.46 mL, 32.06 mmol) added. The mixture was stirred at RT for 72 hours. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and ethyl acetate (100 mL) added to the residue. The organics were washed with water (100 mL), citric acid (50 mL), saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography, eluting with a gradient of 50 -100% ethyl acetate in isohexane, to afford the product (2.38 g, 82%). 1HNMR δ (400 MHZ, CDCl3): 2.35 - 2.42 (2H, m), 4.26 (2H, t), 4.67 (2H, t), 8.52 (IH, d), 9.09 (IH, d); m/z 198 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 33: 5-Chloropyrazine-2-carboxylic acid
Figure imgf000099_0002
To a solution of methyl-5-chloropyrazine-2-carboxylate (120 mg, 0.70 mmol) in a mixture of acetonitrile (2 mL) and DMF (1 mL) was added lithium chloride (295 mg, 6.95 mmol). The suspension was heated to 160°C for 5 minutes in a microwave after which time the reaction was diluted with water (10 mL). Saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (20 mL) was added and the aqueous layered extracted with ethyl acetate (2x30 mL). The organic extracts were discarded and the aqueous layer adjusted to pH 4 with IN hydrochloric acid. The aqueous phase was extracted twice with ethyl acetate (20 mL) and the combined organics washed with water (2x20 mL) and brine (10 mL) and dried (MgSO4). The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure to afford the product (68 mg). 1H NMR δ (400 MHZ, CDCl3): 7.20 (IH, br s), 8.72 (IH, s), 9.21 - 9.21 (IH, m); m/z 157 (M-H)+.
Intermediate 34: Azetidin-l-vH5-bromopyridin-2-vDmethanone
Figure imgf000100_0001
Oxalyl chloride (11.5 mL, 130 mmol) then DMF (2 drops) were added to a mixture of 5- bromopyridine-2-carboxylic acid (CAS no. 30766-11-1) (12.6 g, 62.4 mmol) in 4M HCl in dioxane (15.6 mL, 74.9 mmol) and DCM (300 mL). The mixture was stirred at ambient temperature for 18 hours. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and azeotroped with toluene. The residue was dissolved in DCM (300 mL). Azetidine hydrochloride (6.14 g, 65.5 mmol) then triethylamine (24 mL, 187 mmol) were added and the mixture stirred at ambient temperature for 20 hours. The mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure and ethyl acetate (400 mL) added to the residue. The resulting mixture was washed with water (100 mL), filtered, washed with IM citric acid solution (50 mL), saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography, eluting with a gradient of 0-40% ethyl acetate in isohexane to afford the product (8.8 g, 65%). m/z 242 (M+H)+.
Intermediate 35: 10-Fluoro-5-methyl-2-oxa-6λ6 -thia-5-azabicvclo 15.4.01 undeca-8,10,12- triene 6,6-dioxide
Figure imgf000100_0002
Sodium hydride (60% dispersion in mineral oil) (700 mg, 17.5 mmol) was added to a solution of 2,4-difluoro-N-(2-hydroxyethyl)-N-methyl-benzenesulfonamide (Intermediate 36) (2.0 g, 8.0 mmol) in DMF (200 mL) and the mixture stirred for 48 hours. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure, iced water (200 mL) was added and the mixture extracted into ethyl acetate (2x300 mL). The combined organic extract was washed with brine (40 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography, eluting with 20-50% ethyl acetate in isohexane, to afford the product (1.08 g, 58%). 1H NMR δ (400MHZ, CDCl3): 2.79 (s, 3H), 3.75 (t, 2H), 4.23 (t, 2H), 6.88 - 6.97 (m, 2H), 7.82 - 7.86 (m, IH); m/z 230 (M-H)'
Intermediate 36: 2,4-Difluoro-N-(2-hvdroxyethylVN-methyl-benzenesulf<)namide
Figure imgf000101_0001
2,4-Difiuorobenzenesulfonyl chloride (CAS no. 13918-92-8) (4.0 g, 19 mmol) in DCM (10 mL) was added slowly to a solution of 2-(methylamino)ethanol (1.66 mL, 20.7 mmol) in DCM (200 mL) and 10% sodium hydroxide solution (200 mL) at 00C. The reaction was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 20 hours. The DCM layer was separated and the aqueous re-extracted into DCM (2x50 mL). The combined organic extracts were washed with brine (200 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated under reduced pressure to afford the product (4.7 g, 98%). 1H NMR δ (400MHz, CDCl3): 1.98 (t, IH), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.32 (t, 2H), 3.79 (q, 2H), 6.94 - 7.03 (m, 2H), 7.89 - 7.95 (m, IH).
Figure imgf000101_0002
3-Chloro-2,4-difluorobenzoylchloride (CAS no. 157373-00-7) (211 mg, 1 mmol) in DCM (1 mL) was added to a stirred solution of 2-(methylamino)ethanol (83 mg, 1.1 mmol) in a mixture of DCM (1 mL) and 10% sodium hydroxide solution (1 mL) at O0C. The mixture was warmed to room temperature and stirred for approximately 4 hours. The two layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with DCM (3x30mL). The organic layers were combined, dried (MgSO4), filtered and evaporated to afford the product (180 mg, 61%). 1H NMR δ (400MHz, CDCl3): 3.01 (s, 3H), 3.37 (t, IH), 3.74 (t, 2H), 3.92 (t, 2H), 7.06 (td, IH), 7.28 - 7.37 (m, IH).
Figure imgf000102_0001
A mixture of 4-fluoro-2-hydroxy-N-methyl-benzamide (Intermediate 39) (0.30 g, 1.8 mmol) in formaldehyde (37% aqueous solution, 2 mL) and formic acid (2 mL) was refluxed for 1 hour then poured onto ice. The mixture was neutralised with sodium carbonate and extracted into chloroform (3x30 mL). The combined organics were dried (MgSO4), and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography, eluting with 10- 50% ethyl acetate in isohexane to afford the product (0.24 g, 74%). 1H NMR δ (400MHZ, CDCl3): 3.12 (s, 3H), 5.21 (s, 2H), 6.69 (dd, IH), 6.84 (td, IH), 7.98 (dd, IH)
Intermediate 39: 4-Fluoro-2-hvdroxy-N-methyl-benzamide
Figure imgf000102_0002
DMF (2 drops) was added to a mixture of 4-fluoro-2-hydroxy-benzoic acid (2.0 g, 13 mmol) and oxalyl chloride (2.85 mL, 32.0 mmol) in THF (15 mL). The reaction was stirred for 2 hours then evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in THF (10 mL) and added dropwise to 2M methylamine in THF (32 mL) at O0C. The reaction was stirred at RT for 72 hours and the THF removed under reduced pressure. The residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate (80 mL) and water (80 mL). The aqueous layer was further extracted into ethyl acetate (80 mL) and the combined organic extracts were washed with brine (50 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography, eluting with 5-40% ethyl acetate in isohexane, to afford the product (1.43 g, 65%). 1H NMR δ (CDCl3): 3.04 (d, 3H), 6.25 (s, IH), 6.58 (td, IH), 6.70 (dd, IH), 7.34 (dd, IH), 12.72 (s, IH); m/z 170 (M+H)+. Intermediate 40: tert-Butyl 3-l[3-r(2:2-dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicvelor5A01undeca-7,9αi- trien-9-v0oxyl-54(3SM-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-benzoyl1aminolpyrazole-l- carboxylate
Figure imgf000103_0001
l-Chloro-N,N,2-trimethyl-prop-l -en- 1 -amine (0.142 mL, 1.07 mmol) was added to a solution of the 3-[(2,2-dioxo-6-oxa-2-_λ 6-thiabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-7,9,l l-trien-9-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l- methyl-2~oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoic acid (Intermediate 41) (355 mg, 0.8 mmol) in dichloromethane (10 mL) and stirred at ambient temperature for 30 minutes. tert-Butyl 3- aminopyrazole-1-carboxylate (CAS no. 863504-94-1) (293 mg, 1.6 mmol) and pyridine (0.13 mL, 1.6 mmol) were added and the reaction stirred for 20 hours. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was taken up in ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with water (2 x 10 mL), citric acid (IN, 1O mL), saturated sodium bicarbonate solution (10 mL) and brine (10 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with a gradient of 0-100% ethyl acetate in isohexane to afford the product (412 mg, 84%). mlz 613 (MH-H+)
Intermediate 41: 3-IY2,2-Dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ -thiabicyclorSAOlundeca^Λll-trien-g- yl)oxyl-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-benzoic aeid
Figure imgf000103_0002
Methyl 3-[(2,2-dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-7,9,l l-trien-9-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l- methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 42) (876 mg, 1.9 mmol) was dissolved in THF (18 mL) and methanol (6 mL) and LiOH (IN, 2.3 mL) was added followed by water (20 mL). The resulting mixture was stirred for 16 hours at room temperature. The majority of the organic solvent was removed by distillation, the remaining aqueous solution was filtered then acidified with 2N HCl and extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 30 mL). The combined organic extracts were washed with water (2 x 20 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and the solvent removed under reduced pressure to afford the product (823 mg, 95%). 1H NMR δ (300.072 MHz, CDCl3) 2.13 - 2.26 (m, IH), 2.34 - 2.45 (m, 2H), 2.55 - 2.69 (m, IH), 2.97 (s, 3H), 3.29 - 3.62 (m, 4H), 4.22 (t, 2H), 5.00 (t, IH), 6.72 (s, IH), 6.79 (d, IH), 6.87 (s, IH), 7.28 (s, IH), 7.58 (s, IH), 7.86 (d, IH); mlz 448 (M+H÷).
Intermediate 42: Methyl 3-[(2,2-dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicyclor5.4.01undeca-7,9.,ll-trien- 9-vOoxyl-5-F(3S)-l-methvI-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-benzoate
Figure imgf000104_0001
A mixture of methyl 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 8) (795 mg, 3 mmol), 9-fluoro-6-oxa-2-λβ-thiabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8,10,12- triene 2,2-dioxide (Intermediate 23) (779 mg, 3.6 mmol) and potassium carbonate (828 mg,
6 mmol) in acetonitrile (30 mL) was stirred in the microwave at 1600C for 5 hours. The solution was evaporated under reduced pressure, the residue dissolved in ethyl acetate
(40 mL), washed with water (2 x 20 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and the solvent removed under reduced pressure. The aqueous phase was acidified with 2N HCl extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 30 mL), washed with water (2 x 20 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried
(MgSO4), and evaporated under reduced pressure. The residue from the second extraction was dissolved in THF (2 mL) and methanol (1 mL) and treated with 2M TMS diazomethane
(0.22 mL), stirred for 30 minutes then evaporated. The resulting residue was combined with that from the initial extraction and purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0-
4% methanol in DCM and further purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 50-
100% ethyl acetate in isohexane to afford the product (876 mg, 63%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.11 - 2.27 (m, IH), 2.38 - 2.48 (m, 2H), 2.52 - 2.67 (m, IH), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.30 - 3.56 (m, 4H), 3.90 (s, 3H), 4.24 (t, 2H), 4.91 (t, IH), 6.73 (s, IH), 6.85 (d, IH), 7.00 (s, IH), 7.35 (s, IH), 7.56 (s, IH), 7.91 (d, IH); mlz 462 (M+H+).
Intermediate 43: 3-[(9-methyl-10-oxo-7-oxa-9-azabicyclof4.4.01deca-2,4,ll-trien-4- vDoxyl -5-1(3 S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrr olidin-3-vU oxy-b enzoic acid
Figure imgf000105_0001
Methyl 3-[(4-methyl-5-oxo-2-oxa-4-azabicyclo[4.4.0]deca-6,8,10-trien-9-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l- methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 44) (232 mg, 0.54 mmol) was dissolved in THF (6 niL) and methanol (2 mL) and lithium hydroxide (IN, 0.65 mL) was added followed by water (10 mL), the resulting mixture was stirred for 16 hours at room temperature. The majority of the organic solvent was removed by evaporation under reduced pressure. The remainder was filtered, acidified to pH 1 with 2N hydrochloric acid. The mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 30 mL). The combined organic extracts were washed with water (2 x 20 mL), brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated to afford the product (209 mg, 95%). 1R NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.12 - 2.24 (m, IH), 2.54 - 2.68 (m, IH), 2.96 (s, 3H), 3.08 (s, 3H), 3.35 - 3.58 (m, 2H), 4.98 (t, IH), 5.13 (s, 2H), 6.47 (s, IH), 6.69 (d, IH), 6.89 (s, IH), 7.30 (s, IH), 7.54 (s, IH), 7.88 (d, IH); mlz 413 (M+H+).
Intermediate 44: Methyl 3-f(4-methyl-5-oxo-2-oxa-4-azabicvclo[4.4.01deca-6,8,10-trien- 9-vDoxyl-5-[(3SVl-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-benzoate
Figure imgf000105_0002
A mixture of methyl 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 8) (0.27 g, 1 mmol), 9-fluoro-4-methyl-2-oxa-4-azabicyclo[4.4.0]deca-6,8,10- trien-5-one (CAS no. 915771-24-3) (200 mg, 11 mmol) and potassium carbonate (276 g, 2 mmol) in acetonitrile (2O mL) was heated in a microwave at 16O0C for 12 hours. The mixture was evaporated and the residue partitioned between ethyl acetate (40 mL) and water (40 mL). The organic phase was separated, washed with water (10 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated. The aqueous phase was acidified to pH 1 with 2N hydrochloric acid extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 30 mL). The combined organic extracts were washed with water (2 x 20 mL), brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated. The residue was dissolved in THF (2 mL) and methanol (1 mL) and treated with 2M TMS- diazomethane (0.14 mL) stirred for 30 minutes. The mixture was evaporated and the residue combined with that from the initial extraction and purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 0 to 100% ethyl acetate in isohexane to afford the product (232 mg, 54%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.10 - 2.25 (m, IH), 2.53 - 2.66 (m, IH), 2.93 (s, 3H), 3.09 (s, 3H), 3.32 - 3.58 (m, 2H), 3.89 (s, 3H), 4.91 (t, IH), 5.17 (s, 2H), 6.51 (s, IH), 6.72 (d, IH), 6.97 (s, IH), 7.34 (s, IH), 7.52 (s, IH), 7.93 (d, IH); mlz 427 (M+H+).
Intermediate 45; 3-f5-(Dimethylcarbamoyl)pyrazin-2-ylloxy-5-[(3SVl-methvI-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-vUoxy-benzoie acid
Figure imgf000106_0001
The methyl 3-[5-(dimethylcarbamoyl)pyrazin-2-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 46) (772 mg, 1.86 mmol) was dissolved in THF (9 mL) and methanol (3 mL) and lithium hydroxide solution (IN, 2.2 mL) was added followed by water (25 mL). The resulting mixture was stirred for 1 hour at room temperature. The majority of the organic solvent was removed by distillation under reduced pressure. The remaining aqueous solution was extracted with ethyl acetate (10 mL) then acidified with 2N citric acid and re-extracted with ethyl acetate (5 x 25 mL), the combined organic extracts were washed with water (10 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated to afford the product (716 mg, 96%). 1H NMR δ (300 MHz, CDCl3) 2.13 - 2.27 (m, IH), 2.55 - 2.69 (m, IH), 2.96 (s, 3H), 3.17 (d, 6H), 3.35 - 3.58 (m, 2H), 4.98 (t, IH), 7.10 (s, IH), 7.45 (s, IH), 7.63 (s, IH), 8.36 (s, IH), 8.53 (s, IH); mlz 401 (M+H+).
Intermediate 46: Methyl 3-[5-(dimethylcarbamovi)pyrazin-2-ylloxy-5-f(3S)-l-methyl-2- oxo-pyrrolidin-3-ylloxy-benzoate
Figure imgf000107_0001
A mixture of methyl 3-hydroxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-benzoate (Intermediate 8) (530 mg, 2 mmol), 5-chloro-N,N-dimethyl-pyrazine-2-carboxamide (CAS no. 915949-00-7) (446 mg, 2.4 mmol) and potassium carbonate (552 mg, 4 mmol) in acetonitrile (15 mL) was stirred at 120°C for 2 hours. The mixture was evaporated and the residue dissolved in ethyl acetate (30 mL), washed with water (2 x 10 mL) and brine (20 mL), dried (MgSO4) and evaporated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography on silica eluting with 50 to 100% ethyl acetate in isohexane to afford the product (772 mg, 93%). mlz 415 (M+H+).
BIOLOGICAL
Tests:
The biological effects of the compounds of formula (I) may be tested in the following way: (1) Enzymatic activity
Enzymatic activity of recombinant human pancreatic GLK may be measured by incubating GLK, ATP and glucose. The rate of product formation may be determined by coupling the assay to a G-6-P dehydrogenase, NADP/NADPH system and measuring the linear increase with time of optical density at 340nm (Brocklehurst et al (Diabetes 2004, 53, 535-541 ). Activation of GLK by compounds can be assessed using this assay in the presence or absence of GLKRP as described in Brocklehurst et al (Diabetes 2004, 53, 535-541). One or both of two variants of this assay, GKHl and GKH4, were used to test the compounds of the invention. The GKHl assay is a manual, bench-top rate assay using 60 nmol/1 of recombinant human pancreatic GLK. The GLK activity rate is measured over a 5 minute window using a Multiskan Ascent spectrophotometer. The GKH4 assay is an automated end-point assay using 10 nmol/1 of recombinant human pancreatic GLK. The GLK activity is measured at 10 minutes after the initiation of the assay on a Perkin Elmer Envision spectrophotometer. GKHl and GKH4 do not contain GLKRP.
Compounds of the invention generally have an activating activity for glucokinase with an EC50 of less than about 20μM, such as less than about 5μM, such as less than about lμM, such as less than 50OnM, such as less than about 10OnM. Examples 1 to 32 activated glucokinase in the GKHl and/or GHK4 variants of the assay with EC50 values as shown below. Table A
Figure imgf000108_0001
Figure imgf000109_0001
Production of recombinant GLK and GLKRP:
Human GLK and GLKRP cDNA was obtained by PCR from human pancreatic and hepatic mRNA respectively, using established techniques described in Sambrook J, Fritsch EF & Maniatis T, 1989. PCR primers were designed according to the GLK and GLKRP cDNA sequences shown in Tanizawa et al, Proc Natl Acad Sci 1991 Aug 15;88(16):7294-7 1991 and Bonthron, D.T. et al 1994 (later corrected in and Warner, J.P. et al, Mamm Genome. 1995 Aug;6(8):532-61995).
Cloning in Bluescript II vectors
GLK and GLKRP cDNA was cloned in E. coli using pBluescript II.
Transformations E. Coli transformations were generally carried out by electroporation. 400 mL cultures of strains DH5a or BL21(DE3) were grown in L-broth to an OD 600 of 0.5 and harvested by centrifugation at 2,00Og. The cells were washed twice in ice-cold deionised water, resuspended in ImL 10% glycerol and stored in aliquots at -700C. Ligation mixes were desalted using Millipore V series™ membranes (0.0025mm) pore size). 4OmL of cells were incubated with ImL of ligation mix or plasmid DNA on ice for 10 minutes in 0.2cm electroporation cuvettes, and then pulsed using a Gene Pulser™ apparatus (BioRad) at
0.5IcVCm"1, 25OmF. Transformants were selected on L-agar supplemented with tetracyline at lOmg/mL or ampicillin at lOOmg/mL.
Expression GLK was expressed from the vector pTB375NBSE in E.coli BL21 cells,, producing a recombinant protein containing a 6-His tag immediately adjacent to the N-terminal methionine. Alternatively, another suitable vector is pET21(+)DNA, Novagen, Cat number 697703. The 6-His tag was used to allow purification of the recombinant protein on a column packed with nickel-nitrilotriacetic acid agarose purchased from Qiagen (cat no 30250). GLKRP was expressed from the vector pFLAG CTC (IBI Kodak) in E.coli BL21 cells, producing a recombinant protein containing a C-terminal FLAG tag. The protein was purified initially by DEAE Sepharose ion exchange followed by utilisation of the FLAG tag for final purification on an M2 anti-FLAG immunoaffϊnity column purchased from Sigma- Aldrich (cat no. A1205).
(2) Oral Glucose Tolerance Test TOGTT)
Oral glucose tolerance tests (GJ Coope et al, British Journal of Pharmacology, (2006) 149, 328-335) may be performed on conscious Zucker obese fa/fa rats (age 12-13 weeks or older) fed a high fat diet (45 % kcal fat) for at least two weeks prior to experimentation. The animals are fasted for 2 hours before use for experiments. A test compound or a vehicle is given orally 120 minutes before oral administration of a glucose solution at a dose of 2 g/kg body weight. Blood glucose levels are measured using a Accucheck glucometer from tail bled samples taken at different time points before and after administration of glucose (time course of 60 minutes). A time curve of the blood glucose levels is generated and the area-under-the- curve (AUC) for 120 minutes calculated (the time of glucose administration being time zero). Percent reduction in glucose excursion is determined using the AUC in the vehicle-control group as zero percent reduction. 3) Glucokinase activator efficacy in free feeding obese male Zucker fatty rats The glucose lowering efficacy of a glucokinase was assessed by measuring free feeding blood glucose levels in obese male Zucker fatty rats as follows. Rats were received from the AstraZeneca breeding unit at 9 weeks of age and allowed to acclimatise to a reverse light cycle (0900-2100 dark phase) for 3 weeks. On the study day the animals were split into two groups: vehicle group contains 10 animals and a single test group contains 8 animals; for each additional test group the control group size was increased by 2 animals. Animals were orally dosed, at a volume of 5ml/kg, at 0800 (ie Ih prior to entering the dark phase) with vehicle (1% w/v Pluronic F127) or the test compound (formulated in 1% Pluronic F127) at 3 mg/kg. Blood glucose was measured from a lOμl needle prick sample from the tail vein and determined using a Roche Accu-chek monitor. Measurements were taken at time zero (ie immediately prior to dosing), 0.5h, Ih, 2h, 3h, 4h, 6h, 8h, 12b. and 24h thereafter. Samples at the 12h and 24h time points were only taken if sufficient efficacy had been observed at the 8 hour time point.
REFERENCES
1 Printz, R. L., Magnuson, M. A. and Granner, D. K. (1993) Annual Review of Nutrition
13, 463-96 2 DeFronzo, R. A. (1988) Diabetes 37, 667-87
3 Froguel, P., Zouali, H., Vionnet, N., Velho, G., Vaxillaire, M., Sun, F., Lesage, S., Stoffel, M., Takeda, J. and Passa, P. (1993) New England Journal of Medicine 328, 697- 702
4 Bell, G. L, Pilkis, S. J., Weber, I. T. and Polonsky, K. S. (1996) Annual Review of Physiology 58, 171-86
5 Velho, G., Petersen, K. F., Perseghin, G., Hwang, J. H., Rothman, D. L., Pueyo, M. E., Cline, G. W., Froguel, P. and Shulman, G. I. (1996) Journal of Clinical Investigation 98, 1755-61
6 Christesen, H. B., Jacobsen, B. B., Odili, S., Buettger, C, Cuesta-Munoz, A., Hansen, T., Brusgaard, K., Massa, O., Magnuson, M. A., Shiota, C, Matschinsky, F. M. and
Barbetti, F. (2002) Diabetes 51, 1240-6 - Ill - a Gloyn, A.L., Noordam, K., Willemsen, M.A.A.P., Ellard, S., Lam, W.W.K., Campbell, I. W., Midgley, P., Shiota, C, Buettger, C, Magnuson, M.A., Matschinsky, F.M., and Hattersley, A.T.; Diabetes 52: 2433-2440 Glaser, B., Kesavan, P., Heyman, M., Davis, E., Cuesta, A., Buchs, A., Stanley, C. A., Thornton, P. S., Permutt, M. A., Matschinsky, F. M. and Herold, K. C. (1998) New
England Journal of Medicine 338, 226-30 Caro, J. F., Triester, S., Patel, V. K., Tapscott, E. B., Frazier, N. L. and Dohm, G. L. (1995) Hormone & Metabolic Research 27, 19-22 Desai, U. J., Slosberg, E. D., Boettcher, B. R., Caplan, S. L., Fanelli, B., Stephan, Z., Gunther, V. J., Kaleko, M. and Connelly, S. (2001) Diabetes 50, 2287-95
10 Shiota, M., Postic, C, Fujimoto, Y., Jetton, T. L., Dixon, K., Pan, D., Grimsby, J., Grippo, J. F., Magnuson, M. A. and Cherrington, A. D. (2001) Diabetes 50, 622-9
11 Ferre, T., Pujol, A., Riu, E., Bosch, F. and Valera, A. (1996) Proceedings of the National Academy of Sciences of the United States of America 93, 7225-30 12 Seoane, J., Barbera, A., Telemaque-Potts, S., Newgard, C. B. and Guinovart, J. J. (1999) Journal of Biological Chemistry 274, 31833-8
13 Moore, M. C, Davis, S. N., Mann, S. L. and Cherrington, A. D. (2001) Diabetes Care 24, 1882-7
14 Alvarez, E., Roncero, L, Chowen, J. A., Vazquez, P. and Blazquez, E. (2002) Journal of Neurochemistry 80, 45-53
15 Lynch, R. M., Tompkins, L. S., Brooks, H. L., Dunn-Meynell, A. A. and Levin, B. E. (2000) Diabetes 49, 693-700
16 Roncero, L, Alvarez, E., Vazquez, P. and Blazquez, E. (2000) Journal of Neurochemistry 74, 1848-57 17 Yang, X. J., Kow, L. M., Funabashi, T. and Mobbs, C. V. (1999) Diabetes 48, 1763- 1772
18 Schuit, F. C, Huypens, P., Heimberg, H. and Pipeleers, D. G. (2001) Diabetes 50, 1-11
19 Levin, B. E. (2001) International Journal of Obesity 25, supplement 5, S68-S72.
20 Alvarez, E., Roncero, L, Chowen, J. A., Thorens, B. and Blazquez, E. (1996) Journal of Neurochemistry 66, 920-7
21 Mobbs, C. V., Kow, L. M. and Yang, X. J. (2001) American Journal of Physiology - Endocrinology & Metabolism 281, E649-54 22 Levin, B. E., Dunn-Meynell, A. A. and Routh, V. H. (1999) American Journal of Physiology 276, R1223-31
23 Spanswick, D., Smith, M. A., Groppi, V. E., Logan, S. D. and Ashford, M. L. (1997) Nature 390, 521-5 24 Spanswick, D., Smith, M. A., Mirshamsi, S., Routh, V. H. and Ashford, M. L. (2000) Nature Neuroscience 3, 757-8
25 Levin, B. E. and Dunn-Meynell, A. A. (1997) Brain Research 776, 146-53
26 Levin, B. E., Govek, E. K. and Dunn-Meynell, A. A. (1998) Brain Research 808, 317-9
27 Levin, B. E., Brown, K. L. and Dunn-Meynell, A. A. (1996) Brain Research 739, 293- 300
28 Rowe, I. C, Boden, P. R. and Ashford, M. L. (1996) Journal of Physiology 497, 365-77
29 Fujimoto, K., Sakata, T., Arase, K., Kurata, K., Okabe, Y. and Shiraishi, T. (1985) Life Sciences 37, 2475-82
30 Kurata, K., Fujimoto, K. and Sakata, T. (1989) Metabolism: Clinical & Experimental 38, 46-51
31 Kurata, K., Fujimoto, K., Sakata, T., Etou, H. and Fukagawa, K. (1986) Physiology & Behavior 37, 615-20
32 Jetton T.L., Liang Y., Pettepher CC, Zimmerman E.G., Cox F.G., Horvath K., Matschinsky F.M., and Magnuson M.A., J. Biol. Chem., (Feb 1994) 269: 3641 - 3654. 33 Reimann F. and Gribble F. M., Diabetes 2002 51: 2757-2763
34 Cheung A. T., Dayanandan B., Lewis J. T., Korbutt G. S., Rajotte R. V., Bryer-Ash M., Boylan M. O., Wolfe M. M., Kieffer T. J., Science, 290, Issue 5498, 1959-1962 (8 December 2000)

Claims

Claims:
1. A compound of Formula (I) :
Figure imgf000114_0001
(I) wherein:
R1 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl and (3-6C)cycloalkyl;
HET-I is a 5- or 6-membered, C-linked heteroaryl ring containing a nitrogen atom in the 2- position relative to the amide nitrogen to which the ring is attached and optionally 1 or 2 further ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S; which ring is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R7 and/or on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R6;
Ring A is selected from phenyl, HET-2 and HET-3; wherein when Ring A is phenyl it is substituted by R2 and optionally further substituted by a group selected from R3;
R2 is selected from -C(O)NR4R5, SOpR4, and -SO2NR4R5;
R3 is selected from halo, methyl and trifluoromethyl;
R4 is selected from hydrogen, (l-4C)alkyl [optionally substituted by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from HET-5, -OR5, -SO2R5, (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R15) and -C(O)NR5R5], (3-6C)cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with 1 group selected from R15) and HET-5;
HET-5 is a 4-, 5- or 6-membered, C- or N-linked heterocyclyl ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- , and wherein a sulphur atom in the heterocyclic ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O)2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon or nitrogen atom by 1 or 2 (l-4C)alkyl substituents;
R5 is hydrogen or (l-4C)alkyl; or
R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 4 to 7 membered saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 or 2 further heteroatoms (in addition to the linking N atom) independently selected from O, N and S, wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)- and wherein a sulphur atom in the ring may optionally be oxidised to a S(O) or S(O)2 group; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R8 and/or on an available nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R9; or R4 and R5 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached form a 6-10 membered bicyclic saturated or partially unsaturated heterocyclyl ring, optionally containing 1 further nitrogen atom (in addition to the linking N atom), wherein a -CH2- group can optionally be replaced by a -C(O)-; which ring is optionally substituted on an available carbon by 1 substituent selected from hydroxy, methyl and halo, or on an available nitrogen atom by methyl; R6 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di( 1 -4C)alkylamino(l -4C)alkyl;
R7 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and di(l- 4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl;
R8 is selected from hydroxy, (l-4C)alkoxy, (l-4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1- 4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, di(l-4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, (l-4C)alkylamino, di(l-4C)alkylamino, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and-S(O)p(l-4C)alkyl; R9 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl, aminocarbonyl, (1- 4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, di(l-4C)alkylaminocarbonyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l- 4C)alkyl and-S(0)p(l-4C)alkyl;
HET-2 is a 5- or 6- membered heteroaryl ring, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N; which ring is substituted on an available carbon atom by a substituent selected from R2, and is optionally further substituted on 1 or 2 available carbon atoms by a substituent independently selected from R3 and/or on an available nitrogen atom (provided it is not thereby quaternised) by a substituent selected from R ; R10 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l- 4C)alkyl, -C(O)(I -4C)alkyl, benzyl, and (l-4C)alkylsulfonyl; HET-3 is a fused bicyclic ring system of formula -B-C; wherein B is a Ring is directly attached to the linking oxygen atom and Ring B is phenyl or is a 5- or 6-membered heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or 3 heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S (provided there are no 0-0, S-S or O-S bonds in the ring); wherein Ring B is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R11 and/or on any available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from
R12; R11 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl, di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and HET-4;
R12 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, halo, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy(l-
4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylS(O)p(l-4C)alkyl, amino(l-4C)alkyl, (l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl, di(l-4C)alkylamino(l-4C)alkyl and HET-4;
HET-4 is a 5- or 6-membered, C-or N- linked unsubstituted heteroaryl ring containing 1, 2 or
3 ring heteroatoms independently selected from O, N and S;
Ring C is a 5-7 membered heterocyclic ring fused to Ring B, containing 1, 2 or 3 ring hetereoatoms independently selected from O, S and N (provided that there are no O-O, S-O or S-S bonds within the ring), wherein any ring carbon or sulfur atom may optionally be oxidised and wherein Ring C is optionally substituted on any nitrogen atom by a substituent selected from R13 and/or on any available carbon atom by 1 or 2 substituents independently selected from R14;
R13 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, benzyl, (l-4C)alkylcarbonyl, (1- 4C)alkylsulphonyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and (l-4C)alkoxy(l-4C)alkyl;
R14 is selected from (l-4C)alkyl, (3-6C)cycloalkyl, (l-4C)alkoxy, hydroxy, fluoro and chloro;
R15 is independently selected from (l-4C)alkyl, hydroxy(l-4C)alkyl and hydroxy; n is 0 or 1; p is (independently at each occurrence) 0, 1 or 2; or a salt thereof.
2. A compound of formula (I) as claimed in Claim 1 , or a salt thereof, wherein Ring A is phenyl.
3. A compound of formula (I) as claimed in Claim 1, or a salt thereof, wherein Ring A is HET-2.
4. A compound of formula (I) as claimed in Claim 1 , or a salt thereof, wherein Ring A is HET-3.
5. A compound of formula (I) as claimed in any one of Claims 1 to 4, or a salt thereof, wherein the compound of formula (I) has the (S)-configuration at the pyrrolidone ring and is thereby a compound of formula (IA):
Figure imgf000117_0001
(IA).
6. A compound of the formula (I) as claimed in Claim 1, which is any one of the following compounds, or a salt thereof:
3-[6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-
(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide; 3-[6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-
(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[5-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyrazin-2-yl]oxy-5-[(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-
(4-methyl 1 ,3 -thiazol-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[5-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyrazin-2-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N- (4-methyll,3-thiazol-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[4-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)phenoxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(lH- pyrazol-3-yl)benzamide; 3 - [5 -(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)-3 -chloro-pyridin-2-yl] oxy-5 - [(3S)-I -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 - yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)-5-(4- methylsulfonylphenoxy)benzamide; 3-[4-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)phenoxy]-5-[(3 S)-I -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(2,2-dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-7,9,l l-trien-9-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2- oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-(l-ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl)oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(5-methyl-6,6-dioxo-2-oxa-6-λ6-thia-5-azabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8, 10, 12-trien- 10-yl)oxy]-
5-(l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3 - [6-(azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 - [(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl] oxy-N- pyrazin-2-yl-benzamide; 3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N- pyridin-2-yl-benzamide;
3-[(l 1 -chloro-5-methyl-6-oxo-2-oxa-5-azabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8, 10, 12-trien- 10-yl)oxy]-5-
[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(4-methyl-5-oxo-2-oxa-4-azabicyclo[4.4.0]deca-6,8,10-trien-9-yl)oxy]-5-(l-methyl-2-oxo- pyrrolidin-3-yl)oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(5-methyl-6-oxo-2-oxa-5-azabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8,10,12-trien-10-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l- methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[6-(azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-(l-cyclobutyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl)oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide ; 3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)-l-cyclopropyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-cyclopropyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3- yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3 - [6-( Azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 - [(3 R)- 1 -cyclobutyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl] oxy- N-(5 -methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3S)-l-cyclobutyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-
N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide; 3-[6-(Azetidine-l-carbonyl)pyridin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3R)-l-ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5- methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3 -[6-(Azetidine- 1 -carbonyl)pyridin-3 -yl] oxy-5 - [(3S)-I -ethyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3 -yl] oxy-N-(5 - methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide; N,N-Dimethyl-5-[3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]pyrazine-2-carboxamide;
3-[(2,2-Dioxo-6-oxa-2-λ6-thiabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-7,9, 1 l-trien-9-yl)oxy]-5-[(3 S)- 1 -methyl-
2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(lH-pyrazol-3-yl)benzamide;
3-[2-Chloro-4-(dimethylcarbamoyl)phenoxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N- (5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(6,6-dioxo-2-oxa-6-λ6-thia-5-azabicyclo[5.4.0]undeca-8,10,12-trien-10-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l- methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)benzamide;
3-[(3 S)- 1 -methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(5-methylpyrazin-2-yl)-5-(6- methylsulfonylpyridin-3-yl)oxy-benzamide; N,N-dimethyl-5-[3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(5-methylpyrazin-2- yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]pyridine-2-carboxamide;
3-[(9-methyl-10-oxo-7-oxa-9-azabicyclo[4.4.0]deca-2,4,ll-trien-4-yl)oxy]-5-[(3S)-l-methyl-
2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-N-(lH-pyrazol-3-yl)benzamide;
N,N-dimethyl-5-[3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(3-metliyl-l,2,4-thiadiazol- 5-yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]pyrazine-2-carboxamide; and
N,N-Dimethyl-5-[3-[(3S)-l-methyl-2-oxo-pyrrolidin-3-yl]oxy-5-[(4-methyl-l,3-thiazol-2- yl)carbamoyl]phenoxy]pyrazine-2-carboxamide.
7. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound according to any one of Claims 1 to 6, or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof, together with a pharmaceutically acceptable diluent or carrier.
8. A compound according to any one of Claims 1 to 6 or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof for use as a medicament.
9. The use of a compound according to any one of Claims 1 to 6, or a pharmaceutically- acceptable salt thereof for the preparation of a medicament for treatment of a disease mediated through GLK.
10. The use of a compound according to any one of Claims 1 to 6, or a pharmaceutically- acceptable salt thereof for the preparation of a medicament for treatment of type 2 diabetes.
11. A method of treating GLK mediated diseases by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I) as claimed in any one of Claims 1 to 6 or a pharmaceutically- acceptable salt thereof, to a mammal in need of such treatment.
12. The method of Claim 11 wherein the GLK mediated disease is type 2 diabetes.
13. A compound according to any one of Claims 1 to 6 or a pharmaceutically-acceptable salt thereof for use as a medicament for the treatment of a disease mediated through GLK.
14. A compound according to claim 13 wherein the disease mediated through GLK is type-2 diabetes.
15. A process for the preparation of a compound of Formula (I) as claimed in Claim 1 which comprises a process a) to f) (wherein the variables are as defined hereinbefore for compounds of Formula (I) unless otherwise defined):
(a) reaction of an acid of Formula (V) or activated derivative thereof with a compound of Formula (VI);
Figure imgf000120_0001
(V) (VI); or (b) reaction of a compound of Formula (VII) with a compound of Formula (VIII),
Figure imgf000121_0001
(VII) (VIII) wherein X1 is a leaving group and X2 is a hydroxyl group or X1 is a hydroxyl group and X2 is a leaving group; process (b) could also be accomplished using the intermediate ester Formula (IX), wherein P1 is a protecting group as hereinafter described, followed by ester hydrolysis and amide formation by procedures described elsewhere and well known to those skilled in the art;
Figure imgf000121_0002
(VII) (IX) or
(c) reaction of a compound of Formula (X) with a compound of Formula (XI):
Figure imgf000121_0003
(X) (XI) wherein X3 is a leaving group or an organometallic reagent and X4 is a hydroxyl group or X3 is a hydroxyl group and X4 is a leaving group or an organometallic reagent; process (c) could also be accomplished using the intermediate ester Formula (XII), followed by ester hydrolysis and amide formation by procedures described elsewhere and well known to those skilled in the art;
Figure imgf000122_0001
(d) reaction of a compound of Formula (XIII) with a compound of Formula (XIV),
Figure imgf000122_0002
(XIII) (XIV); wherein X5 is a leaving group; or e) when A is phenyl or HET-2, by reaction of a compound of formula (XV)
Figure imgf000122_0003
(XV) wherein R2a is a precursor to R2, such as a carboxylic acid, ester or anhydride (for R2 =
-CONR4R5) or the sulfonic acid equivalents (for R2 is -SO2NR4R5); with an amine of formula
-NR4R5; f) when A is HET-3, by cyclisation of a compound of formula (XVI) to a compound of formula (I)
Figure imgf000123_0001
(XVI) wherein Y1 and Y2 are 0-4 atom linkers, wherein each linker atom is independently selected from C, N, S or O (wherein any C or S can be optionally oxidised and any atom can be optionally substituted provided it is not quaternised and there are no S-S or 0-0 bonds), X6 can be any nucleophilic species and X7 a leaving group or vice versa; process (f) could also be accomplished using the intermediate ester Formula (XVII), followed by ester hydrolysis and amide formation by procedures described elsewhere and well known to those skilled in the art;
Figure imgf000123_0002
(XVII)
(g) reaction of a compound of Formula (XX) with a (1 -4C)alkylamine or (3- 6C)cycloalkylamine;
Figure imgf000123_0003
and thereafter, if necessary: i) converting a compound of Formula (I) into another compound of Formula (I); ii) removing any protecting groups; and/or iii) forming a salt thereof.
PCT/GB2007/004018 2006-10-23 2007-10-22 Benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds useful in the treatment of a disease mediated through glk Ceased WO2008050101A2 (en)

Priority Applications (8)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
AU2007310608A AU2007310608A1 (en) 2006-10-23 2007-10-22 Benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds useful in the treatment of a disease mediated through GLK
BRPI0718504-9A BRPI0718504A2 (en) 2006-10-23 2007-10-22 COMPOUND OR SALT OF THE SAME, PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION, USE OF COMPOUND OR SALT OF THE SAME PHARMACEUTICALLY ACCEPTABLE, METHOD FOR TREATING GLK-MEDIATED DISEASES, AND PROCESS FOR PREPARING A COMPOUND
EP07824267A EP2086964A2 (en) 2006-10-23 2007-10-22 Benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds useful in the treatment of a disease mediated through glk
JP2009533935A JP2010507640A (en) 2006-10-23 2007-10-22 Compound
CA002667435A CA2667435A1 (en) 2006-10-23 2007-10-22 Chemical compounds
MX2009004362A MX2009004362A (en) 2006-10-23 2007-10-22 Benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds useful in the treatment of a disease mediated through glk.
IL198142A IL198142A0 (en) 2006-10-23 2009-04-16 Benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds useful in the treatment of a disease mediated through glk
NO20091599A NO20091599L (en) 2006-10-23 2009-04-22 Chemical connections

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US86249306P 2006-10-23 2006-10-23
US60/862,493 2006-10-23
US89199307P 2007-02-28 2007-02-28
US60/891,993 2007-02-28

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2008050101A2 true WO2008050101A2 (en) 2008-05-02
WO2008050101A3 WO2008050101A3 (en) 2008-07-17

Family

ID=39324963

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/GB2007/004018 Ceased WO2008050101A2 (en) 2006-10-23 2007-10-22 Benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds useful in the treatment of a disease mediated through glk

Country Status (18)

Country Link
US (1) US7902200B2 (en)
EP (1) EP2086964A2 (en)
JP (1) JP2010507640A (en)
KR (1) KR20090068289A (en)
AR (1) AR063499A1 (en)
AU (1) AU2007310608A1 (en)
BR (1) BRPI0718504A2 (en)
CA (1) CA2667435A1 (en)
CL (1) CL2007003033A1 (en)
CO (1) CO6160318A2 (en)
IL (1) IL198142A0 (en)
MX (1) MX2009004362A (en)
NO (1) NO20091599L (en)
PE (1) PE20081467A1 (en)
RU (1) RU2009114982A (en)
TW (1) TW200825063A (en)
UY (1) UY30660A1 (en)
WO (1) WO2008050101A2 (en)

Cited By (15)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2009021740A2 (en) 2007-08-15 2009-02-19 Sanofis-Aventis Substituted tetrahydronaphthalenes, process for the preparation thereof and the use thereof as medicaments
US7524957B2 (en) 2001-08-17 2009-04-28 Astrazeneca Ab Compounds effecting glucokinase
US7642263B2 (en) 2005-07-09 2010-01-05 Astrazeneca Ab Heteroaryl benzamide derivatives for use as GLK activators in the treatment of diabetes
WO2010150280A1 (en) * 2009-06-22 2010-12-29 Cadila Healthcare Limited Disubstituted benzamide derivatives as glucokinase (gk) activators
WO2011013141A2 (en) 2009-07-31 2011-02-03 Cadila Healthcare Limited Substituted benzamide derivatives as glucokinase (gk) activators
WO2011107494A1 (en) 2010-03-03 2011-09-09 Sanofi Novel aromatic glycoside derivatives, medicaments containing said compounds, and the use thereof
WO2011157827A1 (en) 2010-06-18 2011-12-22 Sanofi Azolopyridin-3-one derivatives as inhibitors of lipases and phospholipases
WO2011161030A1 (en) 2010-06-21 2011-12-29 Sanofi Heterocyclic substituted methoxyphenyl derivatives having an oxo group, method for producing same, and use thereof as gpr40 receptor modulators
WO2012004269A1 (en) 2010-07-05 2012-01-12 Sanofi (2-aryloxy-acetylamino)-phenyl-propionic acid derivatives, method for producing same and use thereof as pharmaceuticals
WO2012004270A1 (en) 2010-07-05 2012-01-12 Sanofi Spirocyclically substituted 1,3-propane dioxide derivatives, methods for the production thereof and use of the same as medicament
WO2012010413A1 (en) 2010-07-05 2012-01-26 Sanofi Aryloxy-alkylene substituted hydroxyphenyl hexynoic acids, methods for the production thereof and use of the same as medicament
WO2013037390A1 (en) 2011-09-12 2013-03-21 Sanofi 6-(4-hydroxy-phenyl)-3-styryl-1h-pyrazolo[3,4-b]pyridine-4-carboxylic acid amide derivatives as kinase inhibitors
WO2013045413A1 (en) 2011-09-27 2013-04-04 Sanofi 6-(4-hydroxy-phenyl)-3-alkyl-1h-pyrazolo[3,4-b]pyridine-4-carboxylic acid amide derivatives as kinase inhibitors
WO2016168633A1 (en) 2015-04-17 2016-10-20 Abbvie Inc. Indazolones as modulators of tnf signaling
US11690841B2 (en) 2017-09-14 2023-07-04 Queen Mary University Of London Glycolysis-activating agents for treatment or prevention of disease

Families Citing this family (9)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
ES2322709T3 (en) * 2004-02-18 2009-06-25 Astrazeneca Ab DERIVATIVES OF BENZAMIDE AND ITS USE AS GLUCOCINASE ACTIVATING AGENTS.
TW200600086A (en) * 2004-06-05 2006-01-01 Astrazeneca Ab Chemical compound
TW200714597A (en) * 2005-05-27 2007-04-16 Astrazeneca Ab Chemical compounds
SA07280576B1 (en) * 2006-10-26 2011-06-22 استرازينيكا ايه بي Benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds as glucokinase (GLK) activators
BRPI0917589A2 (en) 2008-08-04 2015-11-17 Astrazeneca Ab compound, pharmaceutical composition, use of a compound, method for treating disease, process, pharmaceutical combination, and reaction of methyloxyran-2-carboxylate (ix) with a roh alcohol
GB0902434D0 (en) * 2009-02-13 2009-04-01 Astrazeneca Ab Chemical process
GB0902406D0 (en) * 2009-02-13 2009-04-01 Astrazeneca Ab Crystalline polymorphic form
WO2010116176A1 (en) * 2009-04-09 2010-10-14 Astrazeneca Ab Pyrazolo [4, 5-e] pyrimidine derivative and its use to treat diabetes and obesity
AR076220A1 (en) 2009-04-09 2011-05-26 Astrazeneca Ab DERIVATIVES OF PIRAZOL [4,5 - E] PYRIMIDINE

Family Cites Families (90)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US2750393A (en) * 1954-12-01 1956-06-12 Sterling Drug Inc Iodinated 5-henzamidotetrazoles and preparation thereof
US2967194A (en) * 1958-05-15 1961-01-03 Pennsalt Chemicals Corp 4-trifluoromethylsalicylamides
FR1526074A (en) 1967-03-22 1968-05-24 Rech S Ind S O R I Soc D Methoxy-phenyl-amino-2-thiazoles, their amides and processes for their preparation
GB1352415A (en) 1970-05-03 1974-05-08 Boots Co Ltd Esters of substituted nicotine acids
FR2088019A1 (en) 1970-05-08 1972-01-07 Rabot Ets David Esters of 2 and 6-substituted nicotinic acids - with vasomotor active
CS173097B1 (en) 1972-12-01 1977-02-28
GB1400540A (en) * 1972-12-06 1975-07-16 Smith Kline French Lab Salicylamides and compositions thereof
US4009174A (en) * 1972-12-08 1977-02-22 The Boots Company Limited Esters of substituted nicotinic acids
GB1437800A (en) * 1973-08-08 1976-06-03 Phavic Sprl Derivatives of 2-benzamido-5-nitro-thiazoles
JPS5734314B2 (en) 1973-12-22 1982-07-22
GB1561350A (en) 1976-11-05 1980-02-20 May & Baker Ltd Benzamide derivatives
FR2344284A1 (en) * 1976-03-17 1977-10-14 Cerm Cent Europ Rech Mauvernay NEW TRICYCLIC COMPOUNDS WITH A FURANNIC CYCLE AND THEIR APPLICATION AS ANTIDEPRESSANTS
GB1588242A (en) 1977-10-28 1981-04-23 May & Baker Ltd N-(tetrazol-5-yl)-salicylamide derivatives
US4474792A (en) * 1979-06-18 1984-10-02 Riker Laboratories, Inc. N-Tetrazolyl benzamides and anti-allergic use thereof
JPS5721320A (en) 1980-07-11 1982-02-04 Chugai Pharmaceut Co Ltd Blood sugar level depressing agent
JPS5775962A (en) 1980-10-29 1982-05-12 Shionogi & Co Ltd 2-alkoxybenzamide derivative
FR2493848B2 (en) * 1980-11-07 1986-05-16 Delalande Sa NOVEL NOR-TROPANE AND GRANATANE DERIVATIVES, THEIR PREPARATION PROCESS AND THEIR THERAPEUTIC APPLICATION
JPS5869812A (en) 1981-10-22 1983-04-26 Chugai Pharmaceut Co Ltd Blood sugar level depressing agent
JPS59139357A (en) * 1983-01-28 1984-08-10 Torii Yakuhin Kk Amidine derivative
JPS61205937A (en) 1985-03-09 1986-09-12 Konishiroku Photo Ind Co Ltd Silver halide color photographic sensitive material
JPS62142168A (en) 1985-10-16 1987-06-25 Mitsubishi Chem Ind Ltd Thiazole derivatives and leukotriene anti-inflammatory agents containing them as active ingredients
JPS62158252A (en) 1985-12-28 1987-07-14 Kirin Brewery Co Ltd 4-aminopyridinebenzamide derivative
CA1327358C (en) 1987-11-17 1994-03-01 Morio Fujiu Fluoro cytidine derivatives
JP2852659B2 (en) 1988-03-03 1999-02-03 富山化学工業株式会社 Piperazine derivatives and their salts
DE3822449A1 (en) 1988-07-02 1990-01-04 Henkel Kgaa OXIDATION HAIR AGENT WITH NEW COUPLERS
JPH04300874A (en) 1991-03-29 1992-10-23 Tsumura & Co New 2,4-diamino-1,3,5-triazine derivative
JPH04300832A (en) 1991-03-29 1992-10-23 Tsumura & Co Leukotriene antagonistic agent containing 2,4-diamino-1,3,5-triazine derivative as active ingredient
US5258407A (en) * 1991-12-31 1993-11-02 Sterling Winthrop Inc. 3,4-disubstituted phenols-immunomodulating agents
US5466715A (en) * 1991-12-31 1995-11-14 Sterling Winthrop Inc. 3,4-disubstituted phenols-immunomodulating agents
US5273986A (en) * 1992-07-02 1993-12-28 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Cycloalkylthiazoles
JPH0627025A (en) 1992-07-06 1994-02-04 Toto Ltd Molecule recognizing function film and sensor employing it
EP0619116A3 (en) 1993-04-05 1994-11-23 Hoechst Japan Use of synthetic retinoids for osteopathy.
GB9307527D0 (en) 1993-04-13 1993-06-02 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co New venzamide derivatives,processes for the preparation thereof and pharmaceutical composition comprising the same
US5661153A (en) * 1994-07-19 1997-08-26 Japan Energy Corporation 1-arylpyrimidine derivatives and pharmaceutical use thereof
US5792109A (en) 1994-09-01 1998-08-11 Leland L. Ladd Irrigation pump and system
JPH08143565A (en) 1994-11-16 1996-06-04 Fujisawa Pharmaceut Co Ltd Benzamide compound
US5510478A (en) * 1994-11-30 1996-04-23 American Home Products Corporation 2-arylamidothiazole derivatives with CNS activity
US5672750A (en) * 1994-12-16 1997-09-30 Eastman Chemical Company Preparation of aromatic amides from carbon monoxide, an amine and an aromatic chloride
US5849735A (en) * 1995-01-17 1998-12-15 American Cyanamid Company Tricyclic benzazepine vasopressin antagonists
JPH08301760A (en) 1995-05-10 1996-11-19 Shiseido Co Ltd Skin preparation for external use
JP3168915B2 (en) 1995-05-25 2001-05-21 田辺製薬株式会社 Pharmaceutical composition
US5712270A (en) * 1995-11-06 1998-01-27 American Home Products Corporation 2-arylamidothiazole derivatives with CNS activity
JP3735741B2 (en) 1995-11-24 2006-01-18 株式会社大塚製薬工場 Fused pyrimidine derivative
JPH10101672A (en) 1996-08-06 1998-04-21 Otsuka Pharmaceut Factory Inc Adenosine enhancer
JPH10101671A (en) 1996-08-08 1998-04-21 Otsuka Pharmaceut Factory Inc Nitric oxide synthase inhibitor
AUPO395396A0 (en) * 1996-12-02 1997-01-02 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Benzamide derivatives
FR2757852B1 (en) * 1996-12-31 1999-02-19 Cird Galderma STILBENIC COMPOUNDS WITH ADAMANTYL GROUP, COMPOSITIONS CONTAINING SAME, AND USES
JPH10212271A (en) 1997-01-31 1998-08-11 Zeria Pharmaceut Co Ltd N-substituted benzoylamine derivatives, medicaments containing them and intermediates for the production of said compounds
JPH1129480A (en) 1997-05-12 1999-02-02 Otsuka Pharmaceut Factory Inc Pharmaceutical composition containing fused pyrimidine derivative
BR9810456A (en) * 1997-06-27 2001-09-25 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co Sulfonamide compound, method for obtaining it and its pharmaceutical use
DE69826286T2 (en) * 1997-06-27 2005-11-24 Fujisawa Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. DERIVATIVES WITH AN AROMATIC RING
US6613942B1 (en) * 1997-07-01 2003-09-02 Novo Nordisk A/S Glucagon antagonists/inverse agonists
US6114483A (en) 1997-08-27 2000-09-05 E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Polymerization of olefins
JP4398585B2 (en) 1997-11-12 2010-01-13 有限会社ケムフィズ Retinoid receptor agonist
GB9725298D0 (en) 1997-11-28 1998-01-28 Zeneca Ltd Insecticidal thiazole derivatives
JP4253126B2 (en) * 1998-01-29 2009-04-08 アムジェン インコーポレイテッド PPAR-gamma modulator
DE19816780A1 (en) * 1998-04-16 1999-10-21 Bayer Ag New tryptamine derivatives useful as antibacterial agents for treating infections in humans and especially animals
GB9811969D0 (en) * 1998-06-03 1998-07-29 Celltech Therapeutics Ltd Chemical compounds
US6197798B1 (en) * 1998-07-21 2001-03-06 Novartis Ag Amino-benzocycloalkane derivatives
JP4191825B2 (en) 1998-09-10 2008-12-03 あすか製薬株式会社 5-aminoisoxazole derivatives
RU2242469C2 (en) * 1999-03-29 2004-12-20 Ф.Хоффманн-Ля Рош Аг Glucokinase activating agents
US6610846B1 (en) * 1999-03-29 2003-08-26 Hoffman-La Roche Inc. Heteroaromatic glucokinase activators
US6320050B1 (en) * 1999-03-29 2001-11-20 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Heteroaromatic glucokinase activators
AU1917201A (en) * 1999-11-18 2001-05-30 Centaur Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Amide therapeutics and methods for treating inflammatory bowel disease
WO2001064643A2 (en) * 2000-02-29 2001-09-07 Cor Therapeutics, Inc. BENZAMIDES AND RELATED INHIBITORS OF FACTOR Xa
EP1132381A1 (en) 2000-03-08 2001-09-12 Cermol S.A. Ester derivatives of dimethylpropionic acid and pharmaceutical compositions containing them
US6534651B2 (en) * 2000-04-06 2003-03-18 Inotek Pharmaceuticals Corp. 7-Substituted isoindolinone inhibitors of inflammation and reperfusion injury and methods of use thereof
US6388071B2 (en) * 2000-05-03 2002-05-14 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Alkynyl phenyl heteroaromatic glucokinase activators
DE60118774T2 (en) * 2000-11-22 2007-03-15 Astellas Pharma Inc. SUBSTITUTED PHENOL DERIVATIVES AND THEIR SALTS AS INHIBITORS OF COAGULATION FACTOR X
DE60117059T2 (en) * 2000-12-06 2006-10-26 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag CONDENSED HETEROAROMATIC GLUCCOAASE ACTIVATORS
US7132546B2 (en) * 2000-12-22 2006-11-07 Ishihara Sangyo Kaisha, Ltd. Aniline derivatives or salts thereof and cytokine production inhibitors containing the same
EP1357116A4 (en) 2001-02-02 2005-06-01 Yamanouchi Pharma Co Ltd 2-acylaminothiazole derivative or its salt
SE0102299D0 (en) * 2001-06-26 2001-06-26 Astrazeneca Ab Compounds
MXPA04001253A (en) * 2001-08-09 2004-06-03 Ono Pharmaceutical Co Carboxylic acid derivative compounds and drugs comprising these compounds as the active ingredient.
SE0102764D0 (en) * 2001-08-17 2001-08-17 Astrazeneca Ab Compounds
EP1336607A1 (en) 2002-02-19 2003-08-20 Novo Nordisk A/S Amide derivatives as glucokinase activators
US6911545B2 (en) 2001-12-19 2005-06-28 Hoffman-La Roche Inc. Crystals of glucokinase and methods of growing them
WO2003080585A1 (en) 2002-03-26 2003-10-02 Banyu Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Novel aminobenzamide derivative
US20060004010A1 (en) * 2002-07-10 2006-01-05 Hiromu Habashita Ccr4 antagonist and medical use thereof
GB0226931D0 (en) * 2002-11-19 2002-12-24 Astrazeneca Ab Chemical compounds
KR20050105488A (en) 2003-02-26 2005-11-04 반유 세이야꾸 가부시끼가이샤 Heteroarylcarbamoylbenzene derivative
GB0325402D0 (en) * 2003-10-31 2003-12-03 Astrazeneca Ab Compounds
US20050165031A1 (en) * 2003-11-13 2005-07-28 Ambit Biosciences Corporation Urea derivatives as ABL modulators
US7728025B2 (en) 2003-12-29 2010-06-01 Banyu Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. 2-heteroaryl-substituted benzimidazole derivative
TW200600086A (en) * 2004-06-05 2006-01-01 Astrazeneca Ab Chemical compound
AU2006239632B2 (en) 2005-04-25 2012-03-15 Merck Patent Gmbh Novel AZA- heterocycles serving as kinase inhibitors
JP2008542247A (en) * 2005-05-24 2008-11-27 アストラゼネカ アクチボラグ 2-Phenyl substituted imidazole [4,5B] pyridine / pyrazine and purine derivatives as glucokinase modulators
EP2301935A1 (en) * 2005-07-09 2011-03-30 AstraZeneca AB (Publ) Heteroaryl benzamide derivatives for use as GLK activators in the treatment of diabetes
JP2009504621A (en) * 2005-08-09 2009-02-05 アストラゼネカ アクチボラグ Heteroarylcarbamoylbenzene derivatives for the treatment of diabetes
US8680122B2 (en) * 2005-11-01 2014-03-25 Janssen Pharmacetica N.V. Substituted pyrrolones as allosteric modulators of glucokinase

Cited By (22)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7524957B2 (en) 2001-08-17 2009-04-28 Astrazeneca Ab Compounds effecting glucokinase
US7642263B2 (en) 2005-07-09 2010-01-05 Astrazeneca Ab Heteroaryl benzamide derivatives for use as GLK activators in the treatment of diabetes
US7642259B2 (en) 2005-07-09 2010-01-05 Astrazeneca Ab Heteroaryl benzamide derivatives for use as GLK activators in the treatment of diabetes
WO2009021740A2 (en) 2007-08-15 2009-02-19 Sanofis-Aventis Substituted tetrahydronaphthalenes, process for the preparation thereof and the use thereof as medicaments
WO2010150280A1 (en) * 2009-06-22 2010-12-29 Cadila Healthcare Limited Disubstituted benzamide derivatives as glucokinase (gk) activators
US8450494B2 (en) 2009-06-22 2013-05-28 Cadila Healthcare Limited Disubstituted benzamide derivatives as glucokinase (GK) activators
AU2010277171B2 (en) * 2009-07-31 2013-02-07 Cadila Healthcare Limited Substituted benzamide derivatives as glucokinase (GK) activators
WO2011013141A3 (en) * 2009-07-31 2011-03-24 Cadila Healthcare Limited Substituted benzamide derivatives as glucokinase (gk) activators
CN102482267B (en) * 2009-07-31 2014-12-03 卡迪拉保健有限公司 Substituted benzamide derivatives as glucokinase (GK) activators
WO2011013141A2 (en) 2009-07-31 2011-02-03 Cadila Healthcare Limited Substituted benzamide derivatives as glucokinase (gk) activators
CN102482267A (en) * 2009-07-31 2012-05-30 卡迪拉保健有限公司 Substituted benzamide derivatives as glucokinase (GK) activators
JP2013500961A (en) * 2009-07-31 2013-01-10 カディラ ヘルスケア リミテッド Substituted benzamide derivatives as glucokinase (GK) activators
WO2011107494A1 (en) 2010-03-03 2011-09-09 Sanofi Novel aromatic glycoside derivatives, medicaments containing said compounds, and the use thereof
WO2011157827A1 (en) 2010-06-18 2011-12-22 Sanofi Azolopyridin-3-one derivatives as inhibitors of lipases and phospholipases
WO2011161030A1 (en) 2010-06-21 2011-12-29 Sanofi Heterocyclic substituted methoxyphenyl derivatives having an oxo group, method for producing same, and use thereof as gpr40 receptor modulators
WO2012004269A1 (en) 2010-07-05 2012-01-12 Sanofi (2-aryloxy-acetylamino)-phenyl-propionic acid derivatives, method for producing same and use thereof as pharmaceuticals
WO2012010413A1 (en) 2010-07-05 2012-01-26 Sanofi Aryloxy-alkylene substituted hydroxyphenyl hexynoic acids, methods for the production thereof and use of the same as medicament
WO2012004270A1 (en) 2010-07-05 2012-01-12 Sanofi Spirocyclically substituted 1,3-propane dioxide derivatives, methods for the production thereof and use of the same as medicament
WO2013037390A1 (en) 2011-09-12 2013-03-21 Sanofi 6-(4-hydroxy-phenyl)-3-styryl-1h-pyrazolo[3,4-b]pyridine-4-carboxylic acid amide derivatives as kinase inhibitors
WO2013045413A1 (en) 2011-09-27 2013-04-04 Sanofi 6-(4-hydroxy-phenyl)-3-alkyl-1h-pyrazolo[3,4-b]pyridine-4-carboxylic acid amide derivatives as kinase inhibitors
WO2016168633A1 (en) 2015-04-17 2016-10-20 Abbvie Inc. Indazolones as modulators of tnf signaling
US11690841B2 (en) 2017-09-14 2023-07-04 Queen Mary University Of London Glycolysis-activating agents for treatment or prevention of disease

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
TW200825063A (en) 2008-06-16
JP2010507640A (en) 2010-03-11
EP2086964A2 (en) 2009-08-12
IL198142A0 (en) 2009-12-24
AU2007310608A1 (en) 2008-05-02
UY30660A1 (en) 2008-05-31
RU2009114982A (en) 2010-11-27
WO2008050101A3 (en) 2008-07-17
PE20081467A1 (en) 2008-12-07
NO20091599L (en) 2009-07-21
CO6160318A2 (en) 2010-05-20
KR20090068289A (en) 2009-06-25
MX2009004362A (en) 2009-05-05
US7902200B2 (en) 2011-03-08
US20080171734A1 (en) 2008-07-17
BRPI0718504A2 (en) 2013-12-03
CA2667435A1 (en) 2008-05-02
AR063499A1 (en) 2009-01-28
CL2007003033A1 (en) 2008-05-16

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US7902200B2 (en) Chemical compounds
JP4651729B2 (en) Heteroarylbenzamide derivatives for use as GLK activators in the treatment of diabetes
AU2007310624B2 (en) Benzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds as glucokinase (GLK) activators
US20090105214A1 (en) Heteroaryl Benzamide Derivatives for Use as Glk Activators in the Treatment of Diabetes
US20080234273A1 (en) Heteroaryl Benzamide Derivatives for Use as Glk Activators in the Treatment of Diabetes
EP1718625A1 (en) Compounds
WO2007007040A1 (en) 2 -heterocyclyloxybenzoyl amino heterocyclyl compounds as modulators of glucokinase for the treatment of type 2 diabetes
WO2007017649A1 (en) Heteroarylcarbamoylbenzene derivatives for the treatment of diabetes
WO2005121110A1 (en) Hetroaryl benzamide derivatives for use as glk activators in the treatment of diabetes
US20080280874A1 (en) Phenoxy Benzamide Compounds with Utility in the Treatment of Type 2 Diabetes and Obesity
WO2007031739A1 (en) Heterobicyclic compounds as glucokinase activators
US20070287693A1 (en) Benzamide Derivatives That Act Upon The Glucokinase Enzyme

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 200780048084.4

Country of ref document: CN

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2007310608

Country of ref document: AU

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2373/DELNP/2009

Country of ref document: IN

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 198142

Country of ref document: IL

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 09039732

Country of ref document: CO

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2009040544

Country of ref document: EG

Ref document number: 2667435

Country of ref document: CA

Ref document number: 12009500762

Country of ref document: PH

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 576413

Country of ref document: NZ

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2009533935

Country of ref document: JP

Kind code of ref document: A

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: MX/A/2009/004362

Country of ref document: MX

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2007824267

Country of ref document: EP

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2007310608

Country of ref document: AU

Date of ref document: 20071022

Kind code of ref document: A

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 1020097010059

Country of ref document: KR

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2009114982

Country of ref document: RU

Kind code of ref document: A

121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 07824267

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A2

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: PI0718504

Country of ref document: BR

Kind code of ref document: A2

Effective date: 20090422